2013
OWNER’S MANUAL
200
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name Chrysler
Group LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name Chrysler
Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of accidents.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of features and
equipment that are either standard or optional on this vehicle. This
manual may also include a description of features and equipment
that are no longer available or were not ordered on this vehicle.
Please disregard any features and equipment described in this
manual that are not on this vehicle.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood alcohol
levels far below the legal minimum. If you are drinking, don’t drive.
Ride with a designated non-drinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use
public transportation.
Chrysler Group LLC reserves the right to make changes in design
and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its
products without imposing any obligation upon itself to install them
on products previously manufactured.
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident. Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are slower, and your judgment is impaired when you have been drinking. Never drink
and then drive.
Copyright © 2012 Chrysler Group LLC
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487
10
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .6
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .7
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
1
4 INTRODUCTION
When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techCongratulations on selecting your new Chrysler Group
nicians and genuine MOPAR威 parts, and cares about
LLC vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision
your satisfaction.
workmanship, distinctive styling, and high quality - all
essentials that are traditional to our vehicles.
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
INTRODUCTION
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle.
It is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various
customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to
read these publications carefully. Following the instructions and recommendations in this manual will help
assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section
contains the information you desire.
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
contains a complete listing of all subjects.
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it Consult the following table for a description of the
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referenc- symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
ing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
this Owner’s Manual:
INTRODUCTION 5
1
6 INTRODUCTION
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
This Owners Manual contains WARNINGS against operating procedures that could result in a collision or
bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you
do not read this entire Owners Manual, you may miss
important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is on the left
front corner of the instrument panel and is visible from
outside of the vehicle through the windshield. This
number also appears stamped on the right front door sill
under the sill moulding and printed on the Automobile
Information Disclosure Label affixed to a window on
your vehicle, the vehicle registration and title.
Vehicle Identification Number
INTRODUCTION 7
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
Stamped VIN Location
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
1
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ Rearming The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ To Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ Locking the Doors with the Key . . . . . . . . . . . .15 䡵 ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . .21
䡵 SENTRY KEY威 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ To Unlock The Doors. . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Customer Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
▫ To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ To Unlatch The Trunk . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Using The Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .22
. . . . . . . . .22
. . . . . . . . .25
. . . . . . . . .26
. . . . . . . . .26
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Programming Additional Transmitters. . . . . . . .26
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .26
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
䡵 REMOTE START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED . . . .28
▫ How To Use Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Manual Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
▫ Child-Protection Door Lock
System — Rear Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
▫ Auto Window Up With Anti-Pinch
Protection — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
▫ Window Lockout Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
䡵 TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
䡵 TRUNK SAFETY WARNING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
▫ Trunk Internal Emergency Release . . . . . . . . . .41
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
▫ Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
▫ Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure . . . . .50
䡵 POWER WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
▫ Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage . . .51
▫ Power Window Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
▫ Rear Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
▫ Auto Window Down — If Equipped . . . . . . . .37
▫ Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions . . . . . .52
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
▫ Automatic Locking Retractor Mode
(ALR) — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
▫ Energy Management Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
▫ Seat Belt Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
▫ Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR) . . .54
▫ Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls . . . .66
▫ Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
▫ Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
䡵 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . . .96
▫ Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
(BeltAlert威) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
▫ Transporting Passengers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Seat Belts And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . .59
▫ Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside
▫ Supplemental Restraint System
The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
(SRS) — Air Bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make
▫ Air Bag System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Outside The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
▫ Advanced Front Air Bag Features . . . . . . . . . . .62
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
The authorized dealer that sold you your vehicle has the
key code numbers for your vehicle locks. These numbers
can be used to order duplicate keys from your authorized
dealer. Ask your authorized dealer for these numbers
and keep them in a safe place.
You can insert the double-sided keys into the locks with
either side up.
Vehicle Key
Ignition Key Removal
Automatic Transaxle
Place the shift lever in PARK. Turn the ignition switch to
the ACC position, push the key and cylinder inward,
rotate the key to the LOCK position, and remove the key.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
NOTE:
• If you try to remove the key before you place the shift
lever in PARK, the key may become trapped temporarily in the ignition switch lock cylinder. If this occurs,
rotate the key to the right slightly, then remove the key
as described. If a malfunction occurs, the system will
trap the key in the ignition switch lock cylinder to
warn you that this safety feature is inoperable. The
engine can be started and stopped, but the key cannot
be removed until you obtain service.
Ignition Switch Positions
1 — LOCK
2 — ACC (ACCESSORY)
3 — ON/RUN
4 — START
• For vehicles not equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window
switches, radio, hands–free system (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for 45 seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position.
Opening either door will cancel this feature.
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window
switches, radio, hands–free system (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door will cancel this feature.
The time for this feature is programmable. Refer to
“Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/
Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
WARNING!
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, shift the transmission into PARK, and remove the Key Fob from the ignition. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, and
do not leave the ignition in the ACC or ON/RUN
position. A child could operate power windows,
other controls, or move the vehicle.
CAUTION!
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always
remove key from the ignition and lock all doors
when leaving the vehicle unattended.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
key forward. For door lock lubrication, see “Maintenance
Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” of this
Opening the driver’s door when the key is in the ignition
manual.
sounds a signal to remind you to remove the key.
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
NOTE:
SENTRY KEY姞
• The Key-In-Ignition reminder only sounds when the The Sentry Key威 Immobilizer System prevents unauthorignition key is placed in the LOCK or ACC position. ized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
• With either front door open, and the key in the is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
ignition, both the power door locks and Remote Key- or unlocked.
less Entry (RKE) transmitter will not function.
The system uses ignition keys which have an embedded
Locking the Doors with the Key
electronic chip (transponder) to prevent unauthorized
There is only one external door lock cylinder which is vehicle operation. Therefore, only keys that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
located in the driver’s door.
the vehicle. The system will shut the engine off in two
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the
seconds if someone uses an invalid key to start the
door, turn the key rearward. To unlock the door, turn the
engine.
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: A key which has not been programmed is also
considered an invalid key even if it is cut to fit the
ignition switch lock cylinder for that vehicle.
During normal operation, after turning on the ignition
switch, the Vehicle Security Light will turn on for three
seconds for a bulb check. If the light remains on after the
bulb check, it indicates that there is a problem with the
electronics. In addition, if the light begins to flash after
the bulb check, it indicates that someone used an invalid
key to start the engine. Either of these conditions will
result in the engine being shut off after two seconds.
CAUTION!
The Sentry Key威 Immobilizer system is not compatible with some after-market remote starting systems.
Use of these systems may result in vehicle starting
problems and loss of security protection.
All of the keys provided with your vehicle have been
programmed to the vehicle electronics.
Replacement Keys
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the
If the Vehicle Security Light turns on during normal vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once
vehicle operation (vehicle running for longer than 10 a Sentry Key威 has been programmed to a vehicle, it
seconds), it indicates that there is a fault in the electron- cannot be programmed to any other vehicle.
ics. Should this occur, have the vehicle serviced as soon
as possible by an authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
CAUTION!
Always remove the Sentry Key威 from the vehicle and
lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Customer Key Programming
You can program new keys to the system if you have two
valid Sentry Keys威 by performing the following procedure:
At the time of purchase, the original owner is provided 1. Cut the additional Sentry Key威 Transponder blank(s)
with a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN).
to match the ignition switch lock cylinder key code.
The PIN is required for authorized dealer replacement of
keys. Duplication of keys may be performed at an 2. Insert the first valid key into the ignition switch. Turn
the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position for at
authorized dealer or by using the Customer Key Proleast three seconds, but no longer than 15 seconds.
gramming procedure. This procedure consists of proThen, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position
gramming a blank key to the vehicle electronics. A blank
and remove the first key.
key is one which has never been programmed.
NOTE: When having the Sentry Key威 Immobilizer 3. Insert the second valid key into the ignition switch.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position
System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to the
within 15 seconds. After ten seconds, a chime will
authorized dealer.
sound. In addition, the Vehicle Security Light will
begin to flash. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position and remove the second key.
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. Insert a blank Sentry Key威 into the ignition switch.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position
within 60 seconds. After 10 seconds, a single chime
will sound. In addition, the Vehicle Security Light will
stop flashing. To indicate that programming is complete, the indicator light will turn on again for three
seconds and then turn off.
NOTE: If a programmed key is lost, see your authorized
dealer to have all remaining keys erased from the systems memory. This will prevent the lost key from starting
your vehicle. The remaining keys must then be reprogrammed. All vehicle keys must be taken to your authorized dealer at the time of service to be reprogrammed.
General Information
The new Sentry Key威 is programmed. The Remote
The Sentry Key威 system complies with FCC rules part 15
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter will also be proand with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is
grammed during this procedure.
subject to the following conditions:
Repeat this procedure to program up to eight keys. If you
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
do not have a programmed Sentry Key威 contact your
• This device must accept any interference that may be
authorized dealer for details.
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
horn after three minutes, turn off all of the visual signals
after 15 minutes, and then the Vehicle Security Alarm will
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the doors and trunk
rearm itself.
for unauthorized entry and ignition switch for unauthorized operation. While the Vehicle Security Alarm is To Arm The System
armed, interior switches for door locks and decklid
1. Remove the keys from the ignition switch and get out
release are disabled.
of the vehicle.
If something triggers the alarm, the Vehicle Security
2. Lock the door using either the power door lock switch
Alarm will signal for about 18 minutes. For the first 3
(one door must be open) or the LOCK button on the
minutes, the horn will sound intermittently, the headRemote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter (doors can be
lights will turn on, the park lamps and/or turn signals
open or closed), and close all doors.
will flash and the Vehicle Security Light in the cluster will
flash. Then the exterior lights will flash for another 15 NOTE: The Vehicle Security Alarm will not arm if you
minutes.
lock the doors with the manual door lock plungers.
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM — IF EQUIPPED
Rearming The System
If something triggers the alarm, and no action is taken to
disarm it, the Vehicle Security Alarm will turn off the
2
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. The Vehicle Security Light in the instrument cluster
will flash for 16 seconds. This shows that the Vehicle
Security Alarm is arming. During this period, if a door
is opened, the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN,
or the power door locks are unlocked in any manner,
the Vehicle Security Alarm will automatically disarm.
To Disarm The System
Either press the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter
or insert a valid Sentry Key威 into the ignition lock
cylinder and turn the key to the ON/START position.
NOTE:
• The driver’s door key cylinder and the trunk button on
the RKE transmitter cannot arm or disarm the Vehicle
• During the 16-second arming period, if a door is
Security Alarm.
opened or the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN,
the Vehicle Security Alarm will automatically disarm. • The Vehicle Security Alarm remains armed during
trunk entry. Pressing the trunk button will not disarm
• Once armed, the Vehicle Security Alarm disables the
the Vehicle Security Alarm. If someone enters the
unlock switch on the driver door trim panel and
vehicle through the trunk and opens any door, the
passenger door trim panel, the trunk release button on
alarm will sound.
the instrument panel, and the HomeLink威/Garage
The Vehicle Security Alarm is designed to protect your
Door Opener (if equipped).
vehicle; however, you can create conditions where the
Vehicle Security Alarm will give you a false alarm. If one
NOTE:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
of the previously described arming sequences has occurred, the Vehicle Security Alarm will arm regardless of
whether you are in the vehicle or not. If you remain in the
vehicle and open a door, the alarm will sound. If this
occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
If the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed and the battery
becomes disconnected the Vehicle Security Alarm will
remain armed when the battery is reconnected. The
exterior lights will flash, and the horn will sound. If this
occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED
The courtesy lights will turn on when you press the
unlock button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or open any door.
This feature also turns on the approach lighting in the
outside mirrors (if equipped). Refer to “Mirrors” in
“Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
The interior lights will fade to off after approximately 30
seconds or they will immediately fade to off once the
Tamper Alert
ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN from the OFF
If the alarm was triggered, but the warning signals have position.
timed out, the park and taillights flash three times, and
the horn will chirp three times, when unlocking the NOTE:
vehicle with a valid RKE transmitter to alert the driver. • The front courtesy overhead console and door courtesy lights will remain on if the dimmer control is in
the ⬙Dome ON⬙ position (extreme top position).
2
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• The Illuminated Entry system will not operate if the
dimmer control is in the “Dome defeat” position
(extreme bottom position).
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED
This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors, open
the trunk, or activate the Panic Alarm from distances
approximately 66 ft (20 m) using a Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter. The RKE transmitter does not need to
be pointed at the vehicle to activate the system.
NOTE:
Vehicle Key
• The line of transmission must not be blocked with To Unlock The Doors
metal objects.
Press and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE
• Inserting the key into the ignition switch disables all transmitter once to unlock the driver’s door, or twice to
unlock all doors. The turn signal lights will flash to
buttons on the RKE transmitter.
acknowledge the unlock signal. The Illuminated Entry
system (if equipped) will also turn on.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors First
Press
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either
the driver’s door or all doors on the first press of the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter. To change the
current setting, proceed as follows:
2. Release both buttons at the same time.
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the RKE transmitter with the ignition in the LOCK position and the
key removed.
4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
its previous setting.
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle
NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings
the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understandinside the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
system. Opening a door with the system activated will
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to
following procedure:
deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm system.
1. Press and hold the LOCK button on a programmed
RKE transmitter for at least four seconds, but not
longer than 10 seconds. Then, press and hold the
UNLOCK button while still holding the LOCK button.
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the RKE transThe feature will cause the turn signal lights to flash when
mitter with the ignition in the LOCK position and the
the doors are locked or unlocked with the RKE transmitkey removed.
ter. This feature can be turned on or turned off. To change
the current setting, proceed as follows:
4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are in
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understand- the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
system. Opening a door with the system activated will
cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the
deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm system.
following procedure:
Illuminated Approach — If Equipped
1. Press and hold the UNLOCK button on a programmed
RKE transmitter for at least 4 seconds, but not longer This feature activates the headlights for up to 90 seconds
than 10 seconds. Then, press and hold the LOCK when the doors are unlocked with the RKE transmitter.
The time for this feature is programmable on vehicles
button while still holding the UNLOCK button.
equipped with EVIC. For details, refer to “Electronic
2. Release both buttons at the same time.
Flash Lights With Lock
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings • For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the
following steps:
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding
Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
1. Press the LOCK button on a programmed RKE transmitter for at least 4 seconds, but not longer than 10
To Lock The Doors
seconds. Then, press the PANIC button while still
Press and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitholding the LOCK button.
ter to lock all doors. The turn signal lights will flash and
the horn will chirp once to acknowledge the lock signal. 2. Release both buttons at the same time.
Sound Horn With Lock
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter with the
This feature will cause the horn to chirp when the doors
ignition in the LOCK position and the key removed.
are locked with the RKE transmitter. This feature can be
turned on or off. To change the current setting, proceed as 4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
follows:
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with EVIC, refer to “Electronic
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
2
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are in
the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm.
Opening a door with the alarm activated will cause the
alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to deactivate
the Vehicle Security Alarm.
To Unlatch The Trunk
The Panic Alarm will stay on for three minutes unless
you turn it off by pressing the PANIC button a second
time or if the vehicle speed is 5 mph (8 km/h) or greater.
NOTE: You may need to be close to the vehicle when
using the RKE transmitter to turn off the Panic Alarm due
to the Radio Frequency (RF) noises emitted by the
system.
Press the TRUNK button on the RKE transmitter two Programming Additional Transmitters
times to unlatch the trunk.
Refer to Sentry Key威 “Customer Key Programming.”
Using The Panic Alarm
If you do not have a programmed RKE transmitter,
To turn the Panic Alarm feature on or off, press and hold
the PANIC button on the RKE transmitter for at least one
second and release. When the Panic Alarm is on, the
headlights turn on, the park lights will flash, the horn
will pulse on and off, and the Illuminated Entry system
(if equipped) will turn on.
contact your authorized dealer for details.
Transmitter Battery Replacement
The recommended replacement battery is CR2032.
NOTE: Perchlorate Material — special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
1. With the RKE transmitter buttons facing down, use a 2. Remove and replace the battery. Avoid touching the
flat blade screwdriver to pry the two halves of the RKE
new battery with your fingers. Skin oils may cause
transmitter apart. Make sure not to damage the seal
battery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it
during removal.
with rubbing alcohol.
3. To assemble the RKE transmitter case, snap the two
halves together.
General Information
This device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and with
RS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
Separating RKE Transmitter Halves
2. This device must accept any interference that may be
received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
2
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly ap- NOTE: The vehicle must be equipped with an automatic
proved by the party responsible for compliance could transmission to be equipped with Remote Start.
void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
How To Use Remote Start
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal
All of the following conditions must be met before the
distance, check for these two conditions:
engine will remote start:
1. Weak battery in the RKE transmitter. The expected life
• Shift lever in PARK
of a battery is five years.
• Doors closed
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station
tower, airport transmitter, military base, and some • Hood closed
mobile or CB radios.
• Trunk closed
REMOTE START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED
• Hazard switch off
• Brake switch inactive (brake pedal not pressed)
This system uses the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter to start the engine conve- • Ignition key removed from ignition switch
niently from outside the vehicle while still • Battery at an acceptable charge level
maintaining security. The system has a range of
• RKE PANIC button not pressed
approximately 300 ft (91 m).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
• System not disabled from previous remote start event Remote Start Abort Message On Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC) — If Equipped
• Vehicle theft alarm not active
The following messages will display in the EVIC if the
vehicle fails to remote start or exits remote start premaWARNING!
turely:
• Do not start or run an engine in a closed garage or
confined area. Exhaust gas contains Carbon Mon- • Remote Start Aborted — Door Ajar
oxide (CO) which is odorless and colorless. Carbon • Remote Start Aborted — Hood Ajar
Monoxide is poisonous and can cause serious in• Remote Start Aborted — Trunk Ajar
jury or death when inhaled.
• Keep Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitters • Remote Start Aborted — Fuel Low
away from children. Operation of the Remote Start
System, windows, door locks or other controls • Remote Start Aborted — System Fault
could cause serious injury or death.
The EVIC message stays active until the ignition is cycled
to the ON/RUN position.
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Enter Remote Start Mode
Press and release the REMOTE START button
on the RKE transmitter twice within five seconds. The vehicle doors will lock, the parking
lights will flash and the horn will chirp twice (if
programmed). Then, the engine will start and the vehicle
will remain in the Remote Start mode for a 15-minute
cycle.
NOTE:
the ignition switch must be cycled to the ON/RUN
position before you can repeat the start sequence for a
third cycle.
Remote start will also cancel if any of the following occur:
• The engine stalls or RPM exceeds 2500
• Any engine warning lamps come on
• Low Fuel Light turns on
• The hood is opened
• If an engine fault is present the vehicle will start and • The hazard switch is pressed
then shut down 10 seconds later.
• The transmission is moved out of PARK
• For security, power window operation is disabled • The brake pedal is pressed
when the vehicle is in the Remote Start mode.
• The engine can be started two consecutive times (two
15 minute cycles) with the RKE transmitter. However,
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
To Exit Remote Start Mode Without Driving The
Vehicle
DOOR LOCKS
Manual Door Locks
Press and release the REMOTE START button one time or
To lock each door, push the door lock knob on each door
allow the engine to run for the entire 15 minute cycle.
trim panel downward. To unlock each door, pull the
NOTE: To avoid unintentional shut downs, the system inside door handle.
will disable the one-time press of the Remote Start button
for two seconds after receiving a valid remote start
request.
To Exit Remote Start Mode And Drive The Vehicle
Before the end of the 15 minute cycle, press and release
the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter to unlock
the doors and disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm (if
equipped). Then insert the key into the ignition switch
and turn the switch to the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN
position in order to drive the vehicle.
Manual Lock Knob
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• For personal security and safety in the event of an
collision, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children, and do not
leave the ignition in the ACC or ON/RUN position.
A child could operate power windows, other controls, or move the vehicle.
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock all
of the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Power Door Locks
A door lock switch is located on the driver and passenger
door panel. Press this switch to lock or unlock the doors.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
auto door lock feature can be enabled or disabled by your
authorized dealer. Please see your authorized dealer for
service.
Auto Unlock On Exit
The doors will unlock automatically on vehicles with
power door locks if:
1. The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature is enabled.
2. The transmission was in gear and the vehicle speed
returned to 0 mph (0 km/h).
Power Door Lock Switch
Automatic Door Locks — If Equipped
3. The transmission is in NEUTRAL or PARK.
4. The driver door is opened.
The auto door lock feature default condition is enabled.
When enabled, the door locks will lock automatically 5. The doors were not previously unlocked.
when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h). The
6. The vehicle speed is 0 mph (0 km/h).
2
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. A single chime will indicate the completion of the
programming.
The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature can be
enabled or disabled as follows:
5. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle NOTE: Use the Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings in accordance with local laws.
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “UnderstandChild-Protection Door Lock System — Rear
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Doors
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the
To provide a safer environment for children riding in the
following procedure:
rear seat, the rear doors of your vehicle have a ChildProtection Door Lock system.
1. Close all doors and place the key in the ignition.
Auto Unlock On Exit Programming
2. Cycle the ignition switch between LOCK and ON/
RUN and then back to LOCK four times, ending up in
the LOCK position.
3. Press the power door unlock switch to unlock the
doors.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
2
Child-Protection Door Lock Location
The Child-Protection Door Locks are located inside the
rear edge of the door. Insert the tip of the ignition key or
similar flat-bladed object into the lock and rotate approximately one-quarter turn to the lock or unlock position (as
indicated by the stamped icons).
Child Lock Control
WARNING!
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.
Remember that the rear doors can only be opened
from the outside when the Child-Protection locks are
engaged.
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: For emergency exit with the system engaged,
move the lock knob up (UNLOCKED position), roll
down the window, and open the door with the outside
door handle.
POWER WINDOWS
Power Window Switches
The control on the driver’s door has up/down switches
that give you fingertip control of all four power windows.
AUTO Power Window Switch
There is a single window control on the front and rear
passenger’s door trim panel, which operates the front
and rear passenger door windows. The window controls
will operate when the ignition switch is turned to the
ON/RUN or ACC position, and when the accessory
delay feature is active.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
WARNING!
To cancel the Auto-Down movement, operate the switch
either in the up or down direction and release the switch.
Never leave children in a vehicle, with the keys in
the ignition switch. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the windows while operating the power window switches.
Such entrapment may result in serious injury or
death.
For vehicles not equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window switches
will remain active for 45 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned to the LOCK position. Opening either door will
cancel this feature.
Auto Window Down — If Equipped
The front window controls on the driver and passenger
door trim panels have an Auto-Down feature. These
switches are labeled AUTO to indicate this capability.
Push the window switch past the first detent, release, and
the window will go down automatically.
To open the window part way, push the window switch
to the first detent and release it when you want the
window to stop.
For vehicles equipped with EVIC, the power window
switches will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the
ignition switch is turned off. Opening either door will
cancel this feature. The time for this feature is programmable. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center
(EVIC)/Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Auto Window Up With Anti-Pinch Protection — If
Equipped
NOTE:
• If the window runs into any obstacle during autoclosure, anti-pinch protection will reverse the window
direction and then go back down. Remove the obstacle
and use the window switch again to close the window.
To cancel the Auto Up movement, operate the switch
either in the up or down direction and release the switch. • Any impact due to rough road conditions may trigger
the auto reverse function unexpectedly during autoTo close the window part way, lift the window switch to
closure. If this happens, pull the switch lightly to the
the first detent and release it when you want the window
first detent and hold to close window manually.
to stop.
Lift the window switch fully upward to the second
detent, release, and the window will go up automatically.
WARNING!
When the window is almost closed, there is no
anti-pinch protection. To avoid personal injury, be
sure to clear your arms, hands, fingers and all objects
from the window path before closing.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
Reset Auto Up
Anytime the vehicle battery goes dead, the Auto Up
function will be disabled. To reactivate the Auto Up
feature, pull the window switch up to close the window
completely and continue to hold the switch up for an
additional two seconds after the window is closed.
2
Window Lockout Switch
The window lockout switch on the driver’s door allows
you to disable the window control on the other doors. To
disable the window controls on the other doors, press the
window LOCK button. To enable the window controls,
press the window control button again.
AUTO Power Window Switch
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, then open the front and rear
windows together to minimize the buffeting. If the
buffeting occurs with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting.
TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE
Use the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter to open the trunk from
outside the vehicle. From inside the
vehicle the trunk lid can be released by
pressing the TRUNK RELEASE button
located on the instrument panel to the
left of the steering wheel.
NOTE: The shift lever must be in PARK for this button to
operate.
To unlatch the trunk lid from outside the vehicle, press
and release the TRUNK button on the RKE transmitter
two times.
With the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position, the
word “dECK ” will display in place of the odometer
display indicating that the trunk is open. The odometer
display will reappear once the trunk is closed or if the
trip button is depressed.
With the ignition switch in the LOCK position or with the
key out, the word “dECK” will display until the trunk is
closed.
On EVIC-equipped vehicles, the words “Trunk Ajar” will
display.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
TRUNK SAFETY WARNING
WARNING!
2
Do not allow children to have access to the trunk,
either by climbing into the trunk from outside, or
through the inside of the vehicle. Always close the
trunk lid when your vehicle is unattended. Once in
the trunk, young children may not be able to escape,
even if they entered through the rear seat. If trapped
in the trunk, children can die from suffocation or
heat stroke.
Trunk Internal Emergency Release
As a security measure, a Trunk Internal Emergency Release
lever is built into the trunk latching mechanism. In the
event of an individual being locked inside the trunk, the
trunk can be simply opened by pulling on the glow-in-thedark handle attached to the trunk latching mechanism.
Trunk Internal Emergency Release
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS
• Knee bolsters/blockers for front seat occupants
Some of the most important safety features in your • Front seat belts incorporate pretensioners that may
vehicle are the restraint systems:
enhance occupant protection by managing occupant
energy during an impact event
• Three-point lap and shoulder belts for all seating
positions
• All seat belt systems (except the driver’s) include
Automatic Locking Retractors (ALRs), which lock the
• Advanced Front Air Bags for driver and front
seat belt webbing into position by extending the belt
passenger
all the way out and then adjusting the belt to the
• Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR) located
desired length to restrain a child seat or secure a large
on top of the front seats (integrated into the head
item in a seat.
restraint) — if equipped
Please pay close attention to the information in this
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
for the driver and passengers seated next to a window properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as
possible.
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
• An energy-absorbing steering column and steering If you will be carrying children too small for adult-sized
seat belts, the seat belts or the Lower Anchors and Tether
wheel
for CHildren (LATCH) feature also can be used to hold
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
infant and child restraint systems. For more information
on LATCH, refer to Lower Anchors and Tether for
CHildren (LATCH).
NOTE: The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage
inflator design. This allows the air bag to have different
rates of inflation based on several factors, including the
severity and type of collision.
WARNING!
Infants in rear facing child restraints should never
ride in the front seat of a vehicle with a passenger
Advanced Front Air Bag. An air bag deployment can
cause severe injury or death to infants in that position.
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle seat
belt properly (see section on Child Restraints) should be
risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
secured in the rear seat in child restraints or beltposition1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride ing booster seats. Older children who do not use child
buckled up in a rear seat.
restraints or belt-positioning booster seats should ride
properly buckled up in the rear seat. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind them or under their
arm. If a child from 1 to 12 years old (not in a rear facing
child seat) must ride in the front passenger seat, move the
seat as far back as possible and use the proper child
restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”)
2
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
You should read the instructions provided with your
child restraint to make sure that you are using it properly.
2. All occupants should always wear their lap and
shoulder belts properly.
3. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
Air Bags room to inflate.
4. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
side air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
between you and the door.
5. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided
under (If You Need Assistance”.
WARNING!
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belts even though you have
air bags.
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
Bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
WARNING! (Continued)
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC) and Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
also need room to inflate. Do not lean against the
door or window. Sit upright in the center of the
seat.
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• Being too close to the Supplemental Side Air Bag
Inflatable Curtain (SABIC) and/or Seat-Mounted
Side Air Bag (SAB) during deployment could cause
you to be severely injured or killed.
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver
and cause a collision that includes you. This can happen
far away from home or on your own street.
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should
be belted at all times.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the belt to move freely with you under normal
conditions. However, in a collision the belt will lock and
reduce your risk of striking the inside of the vehicle or
being thrown out.
WARNING!
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Wearing a seat belt incorrectly is dangerous. Seat
belts are designed to go around the large bones of
your body. These are the strongest parts of your
body and can take the forces of a collision the best.
• Wearing your belt in the wrong place could make
your injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of part of the belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the seat.
2
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front
seat, next to your arm. Grasp the latch plate and pull
out the belt. Slide the latch plate up the webbing as far
as necessary to allow the belt to go around your lap.
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
3. When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• A belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle will
not protect you properly. The lap portion could ride
too high on your body, possibly causing internal
injuries. Always buckle your belt into the buckle
nearest you.
• A belt that is too loose will not protect you properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
WARNING!
• A belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck
injury. A belt worn under the arm can cause internal injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder
bones. Wear the belt over your shoulder so that
your strongest bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
4. Position the lap belt across your thighs, below your
abdomen. To remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull
up on the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is
too tight, tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt. A
snug belt reduces the risk of sliding under the belt in
a collision.
Positioning The Lap Belt
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The belt forces won’t be at the
strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat belt as
low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted belt may not protect you properly. In a
collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the belt
is straight. If you can’t straighten a belt in your
vehicle, take it to your authorized dealer immediately and have it fixed.
5. Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it is
comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor will withdraw any slack in the belt.
6. To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle.
The belt will automatically retract to its stowed position. If necessary, slide the latch plate down the
webbing to allow the belt to retract fully.
WARNING!
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do
not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they
have been damaged (bent retractor, torn webbing,
etc.).
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/
shoulder belt.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the
anchor point.
2. At about 6 to 12 in (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate,
grasp and twist the belt webbing 180 degrees to create
a fold that begins immediately above the latch plate.
2
3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of
the latch plate.
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the
folded webbing.
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage
In the front seat, the shoulder belt can be adjusted
upward or downward to position the belt away from
your neck. Push anchorage button to release the anchorage, and move it up or down to the position that serves
you best.
Adjustable Anchorage
As a guide, if you are shorter than average, you will
prefer a lower position, and if you are taller than average,
you will prefer a higher position. When you release the
anchorage, try to move it up or down to make sure that
it is locked in position.
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Rear Seat Belts
Driver
N/A
ALR
The shoulder belt anchorages of the rear three-point belts
First Row
are nonadjustable for outboard and center rear passenSecond Row
gers on sedans. The center belt is mounted to the rear
• N/A — Not Applicable
shelf panel and exits through a bezel in the panel.
Center
N/A
ALR
Passenger
ALR
ALR
Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions
• ALR — Automatic Locking Retractor
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR)
which are used to secure a child restraint system. For
additional information, refer to “Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child
Restraints” section. The chart below defines the type of
feature for each seating position.
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an
ALR and is being used for normal usage:
Only pull the belt webbing out far enough to comfortably
wrap around the occupant’s mid-section so as to not
activate the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a
ratcheting sound as the belt retracts. Allow the webbing
to retract completely in this case and then carefully pull
out only the amount of webbing necessary to comfortably wrap around the occupant’s mid-section. Slide the
latch plate into the buckle until you hear a ⬙click.⬙
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
Automatic Locking Retractor Mode (ALR) — If
Equipped
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically prelocked. The belt will still retract to remove any slack in
the shoulder belt. The Automatic Locking Mode is available on all passenger-seating positions with a combination lap/shoulder belt. Use the Automatic Locking Mode
anytime a child safety seat is installed in a seating
position that has a belt with this feature. Children 12
years old and under should always be properly restrained in the rear seat.
How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
the entire belt is extracted.
3. Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will
hear a clicking sound. This indicates the safety belt is
now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
locking mode.
WARNING!
• The belt and retractor assembly must be replaced if
the seat belt assembly Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not
working properly when checked according to the
procedures in the Service Manual.
• Failure to replace the belt and retractor assembly
could increase the risk of injury in collisions.
2
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an Energy
worn snugly and positioned properly.
Management feature in the front seating positions to help
further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the pretencollision.
sioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or
This safety belt system has a retractor assembly that is
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
designed to release webbing in a controlled manner. This
feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR)
the occupant’s chest.
These head restraints are passive, deployable compoSeat Belt Pretensioners
nents, and vehicles with this equipment cannot be readily
The seat belts for both front seating positions are identified by any markings, only through visual inspecequipped with pretensioning devices that are designed to tion of the head restraint. The head restraint will be split
remove slack from the seat belt in the event of a collision. in two halves, with the front half being soft foam and
These devices may improve the performance of the seat trim, the back half being decorative plastic.
Energy Management Feature
belt by assuring that the belt is tight about the occupant
early in a collision. Pretensioners work for all size occupants, including those in child restraints.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
How The Active Head Restraints (AHR) Work
The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) determines
whether the severity, or type of rear impact will require
the Active Head Restraints (AHR) to deploy. If a rear
impact requires deployment, both the driver and front
passenger seat AHRs will be deployed.
When AHRs deploy during a rear impact, the front half
of the head restraint extends forward to minimize the gap
between the back of the occupant’s head and the AHR.
This system is designed to help prevent or reduce the
extent of injuries to the driver and front passenger in
certain types of rear impacts.
2
Active Head Restraint (AHR) Components
NOTE: The Active Head Restraints (AHR) may or may 1 — Head Restraint Front Half
not deploy in the event of a front or side impact. (Soft Foam and Trim)
2 — Seatback
However if during a front impact, a secondary rear
impact occurs, the AHR may deploy based on the severity and type of the impact.
3 — Head Restraint Back Half
(Decorative Plastic Rear Cover)
4 — Head Restraint Guide
Tubes
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
1. Grasp the deployed AHR from the rear seat.
All occupants, including the driver, should not operate a vehicle or sit in a vehicle’s seat until the head
restraints are placed in their proper positions in order
to minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a
collision.
NOTE: For more information on properly adjusting and
positioning the head restraint, refer to “Adjusting Active
Head Restraints” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle”.
Resetting Active Head Restraints (AHR)
Hand Positioning Points On AHR
If the Active Head Restraints are triggered in a collision, 2. Position the hands on the top of the deployed AHR at
you must reset the head restraint on the driver’s and
a comfortable position.
front passenger seat. You can recognize when the Active
Head Restraint has been triggered by the fact that they
have moved forward (as shown in step three of the
resetting procedure).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
3. Pull down then rearward towards the rear of the vehicle
then down to engage the locking mechanism.
2
3 — Final Downward Movement To Engage Locking Mechanism
1 — Downward Movement
2 — Rearward Movement
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. The AHR front soft foam and trim half should lock • For safety reasons, have the Active Head Restraints
into the back decorative plastic half.
checked by a qualified specialist at an authorized
dealer.
Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
(BeltAlert姞)
BeltAlert威 is a feature intended to remind the driver and
front passenger (if equipped with front passenger
BeltAlert威) to fasten their seat belts. The feature is active
whenever the ignition is on. If the driver or front seat
passenger is unbelted, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will
turn on and remain on until both front seat belts are
fastened.
The BeltAlert威 warning sequence begins after the vehicle
speed is over 5 mph (8 km/h), by blinking the Seat Belt
NOTE:
Reminder Light and sounding an intermittent chime.
• If you have difficulties or problems resetting the Active Once the sequence starts, it will continue for the entire
duration or until the respective seatbelts are fastened.
Head Restraints, see an authorized dealer.
After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt Reminder
AHR In Reset Position
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
Light remains illuminated until the respective seat belts
are fastened. The driver should instruct all other occupants to fasten their seat belts. If a front seat belt is
unbuckled while traveling at speeds greater than 5 mph
(8 km/h), BeltAlert威 will provide both audio and visual
notification.
The front passenger seat BeltAlert威 is not active when the
front passenger seat is unoccupied. BeltAlert威 may be
triggered when an animal or heavy object is on the front
passenger seat or when the seat is folded flat (if
equipped). It is recommended that pets be restrained in
the rear seat in pet harnesses or pet carriers that are
secured by seat belts, and cargo is properly stowed.
NOTE: Although BeltAlert威 has been deactivated, the
Seat Belt Reminder Light will continue to illuminate
while the driver’s or front passenger (if equipped with
BeltAlert威) seat belt remains unfastened.
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is
the best way to keep the baby safe.
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the belt
across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible.
Keep the belt low so that it does not come across the
abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take
the force if there is a collision.
BeltAlert威 can be enabled or disabled by your authorized
dealer. Chrysler Group LLC does not recommend deac- Seat Belt Extender
tivating BeltAlert威.
If a seat belt is too short, even when fully extended and
when the adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage (if
equipped) is in its lowest position, your authorized
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
dealer can provide you with a seat belt extender. This passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the
extender should be used only if the existing belt is not instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The
long enough. When it is not required, remove the ex- words SRS AIRBAG are embossed on the air bag covers.
tender and store it.
WARNING!
Using a seat belt extender when not needed can
increase the risk of injury in a collision. Only use
when the lap belt is not long enough when it is worn
low and snug, and in the recommended seating
positions. Remove and store the extender when not
needed.
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) — Air Bags
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
Advanced Front Air Bag And Knee Bolster Locations
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat
1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air 2 — Knee Bolster
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
NOTE: The Driver and Passenger Advanced Front Air This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Side Air Bag
Bags are certified to new Federal regulations.
Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) to protect the driver, front,
and rear passengers sitting next to a window. If the
The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage inflator
vehicle is equipped with SABIC, they are located above
design. This allows the air bag to have different rates of
the side windows. The trim covering the side air bags is
inflation that are based on several factors, including the
labeled SRS AIRBAG.
severity and type of collision.
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental SeatThis vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or front
Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) to provide enhanced
passenger seat track position sensors that may adjust the
protection for an occupant during a side impact. The
inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags based upon
SABs are located in the outboard side of the front seats.
seat position.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front NOTE:
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether • Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
the driver or front passenger seat belt is fastened. The
but they will open during air bag deployment.
seat belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the
• After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
Advanced Front Air Bags.
authorized dealer immediately.
2
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Air Bag System Components
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage
system components:
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
• Air Bag Warning Light
which may receive information from the front impact
• Steering Wheel and Column
sensors.
• Instrument Panel
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. This low output
• Knee Impact Bolster
is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy output is
• Driver Advanced Front Air Bag
used for more severe collisions.
• Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC)
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
• Front Seat Belt Pretensioners, Seat Belt Buckle Switch,
and Seat Track Position Sensors
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
WARNING!
• No objects should be placed over or near the air
bag on the instrument panel, because any such
objects could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
collision severe enough to cause the air bag to
inflate.
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
• Do not drill, cut or tamper with the knee bolster in
any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee bolster
such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band radios,
etc.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) may
provide enhanced protection to help protect an occupant
during a side impact. The SAB is marked with an air bag
label sewn into the outboard side of the front seats.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag Label
2
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
When the air bag deploys, it opens the seam between the
front and side of the seat’s trim cover. Each air bag
deploys independently; a left side impact deploys the left
air bag only and a right-side impact deploys the right air
bag only.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC)
SABIC air bags may offer side-impact protection to front
and rear seat outboard occupants in addition to that
provided by the body structure. Each air bag features
inflated chambers placed adjacent to the head of each
outboard occupant that reduce the potential for sideimpact head injuries. The SABIC air bags deploy downward, covering both windows on the impact side.
Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) Location
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
NOTE:
• Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim;
but they will open during air bag deployment.
• Being too close to the SAB and SABIC air bags during
deployment could cause you to be severely injured or
killed.
The system includes side impact sensors that are calibrated to deploy the side air bags during impacts that
require air bag occupant protection.
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC), do not stack luggage or other cargo up
high enough to block the location of the SABIC.
The area where the SABIC is located should remain
free from any obstructions.
• Do not use accessory seat covers or place objects
between you and the side air bags; the performance
could be adversely affected and/or objects could be
pushed into you, causing serious injury.
(Continued)
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Your vehicle is equipped with SABIC air bags, do
not have any accessory items installed which will
alter the roof, including adding a sunroof to your
vehicle. Do not add roof racks that require permanent attachments (bolts or screws) for installation
on the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the
vehicle for any reason.
• Do not allow occupants to extend any part of their
body outside of the window.
protection for the driver and front passenger. Side air
bags also work with seat belts to improve occupant
protection.
Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
The ORC is part of a Federally regulated safety system
required for this vehicle.
The ORC determines if deployment of the front and/or
side air bags in a frontal or side collision is required.
Based on the impact sensor’s signals, a central electronic
Knee Impact Bolsters
ORC deploys the Advanced Front Air Bags, SABIC air
The Knee Impact Bolster helps protect the knees of the bags, Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags, and
front passenger, and position the front occupant for the front seat belt pretensioners, as required, depending on
the severity and type of impact.
best interaction with the Advanced Front Air Bag.
Along with seat belts and pretensioners, Advanced Front Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide addiAir Bags work with the bolsters to provide improved tional protection by supplementing the seat belts in
certain frontal collisions depending on several factors,
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
including the severity and type of collision. Advanced Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all colliFront Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk of sions, and also are needed to help keep you in position,
away from an inflating air bag.
injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions.
The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all
frontal collisions, including some that may produce substantial vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions, truck underrides, and angle offset collisions. On
the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
severe initial deceleration.
The side air bags will not deploy in all side collisions.
Side air bag deployment will depend on the severity and
type of collision.
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the
START or ON/RUN position. If the key is in the OFF
position, in the ACC position, or not in the ignition, the
air bag system is not on and the air bags will not inflate.
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that
may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
Also, the ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning
Light in the instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds for a self-check
when the ignition is first turned on. After the
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration
over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are self-check, the Air Bag Warning Light will turn off. If the
not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should ORC detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it
have deployed.
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
turns on the Air Bag Warning Light, either momentarily Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
or continuously. A single chime will sound if the light Inflator Units
comes on again after initial startup.
The Driver and Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
It also includes diagnostics that will illuminate the instru- Inflator Units are located in the center of the steering
ment cluster Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunction is wheel and on the right side of the instrument panel.
noted that could affect the air bag system. The diagnos- When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large
tics also record the nature of the malfunction.
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
Advanced Front Air Bags. Different air bag inflation rates
WARNING!
are possible, based on several factors, including the
Ignoring the Air Bag Warning Light in your instru- collision type and severity. The steering wheel hub trim
ment panel could mean you won’t have the air bags cover and the upper right side of the instrument panel
to protect you in a collision. If the light does not come separate and fold out of the way as the air bags inflate to
on as a bulb check when the ignition is first turned their full size. The air bags fully inflate in about 50 to 70
on, stays on after you start the vehicle, or if it comes milliseconds. This is about half of the time it takes to
on as you drive, have an authorized dealer service the blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
air bag system immediately.
helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
The Advanced Front Air Bag gas is vented through the you if you are not seated properly, or if items are
vent holes in the sides of the air bag. In this way, the air positioned in the area where the side air bag inflates. This
especially applies to children.
bags do not interfere with your control of the vehicle.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag (SAB)
Inflator Units
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC) Inflator Units
The Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) are During collisions where the impact is confined to a
designed to activate only in certain side collisions.
particular area of the side of the vehicle, the ORC may
deploy the SABIC air bags, depending on the severity
The ORC determines if a side collision requires the side
and type of collision. In these events, the ORC will
air bags to inflate, based on the severity and type of
deploy the SABIC only on the impact side of the vehicle.
collision.
A quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the side
Based on the severity and type of collision, the side air
curtain air bag. The inflating side curtain air bag pushes
bag inflator on the crash side of the vehicle may be
the outside edge of the headliner out of the way and
triggered, releasing a quantity of non-toxic gas. The
covers the window. The air bag inflates in about 30
inflating SAB exits through the seat seam into the space
milliseconds (about one-quarter of the time that it takes
between the occupant and the door. The SAB fully inflate
to blink your eyes) with enough force to injure you if you
in about 10 milliseconds. The side air bag moves at a very
are not belted and seated properly, or if items are
high speed and with such a high force that it could injure
positioned in the area where the side curtain air bag
2
70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
inflates. This especially applies to children. The side • Cut off fuel to the engine.
curtain air bag is only about 3-1/2 in (9 cm) thick when
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
it is inflated.
until the ignition key is turned off.
Because air bag sensors estimate deceleration over time,
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
vehicle speed and damage are not good indicators of
the battery has power or until the ignition key is
whether or not an air bag should have deployed.
removed.
Front And Side Impact Sensors
• Unlock the doors automatically.
In front and side impacts, impact sensors can aid the
In order to reset the Enhanced Accident Response System
ORC in determining appropriate response to impact
functions after an event, the ignition switch must be
events.
changed from IGN ON to IGN OFF.
Enhanced Accident Response System
If A Deployment Occurs
In the event of an impact causing air bag deployment, if
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
the communication network remains intact, and the
immediately after deployment.
power remains intact, depending on the nature of the
event the ORC will determine whether to have the NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
Enhanced Accident Response System perform the follow- collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
ing functions:
the air bag system.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71
If you do have a collision, which deploys the air bags, any
or all of the following may occur:
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning.
• The nylon air bag material may sometimes cause
abrasions and/or skin reddening to the driver and Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have defront passenger as the air bags deploy and unfold. The ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
abrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those bags will not be in place to protect you.
you might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium
floor. They are not caused by contact with chemicals.
WARNING!
They are not permanent and normally heal quickly.
However, if you haven’t healed significantly within a Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
few days, or if you have any blistering, see your doctor protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
seat belt pretensioners, and the front seat belt retracimmediately.
tor assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer im• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like mediately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Conparticles. The particles are a normal by-product of the troller System serviced as well.
process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the
skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
2
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Maintaining Your Air Bag System
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
(Continued)
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
Air Bag Warning Light
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to
eight-second interval.
You will want to have the air bags ready to
inflate for your protection in a collision. The
Air Bag Warning Light monitors the internal
circuits and interconnecting wiring associated
with air bag system electrical components. While the air
bag system is designed to be maintenance free. If any of
the following occurs, have an authorized dealer service
the air bag system immediately.
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving.
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. The air bags may
not be ready to inflate for your protection. Promptly
check the fuse block for blown fuses. Refer to the label
located on the inside of the fuse block cover for the
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during proper air bag fuses. See your authorized dealer if the
the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is fuse is good.
first turned to the ON/RUN position.
2
74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
These data can help provide a better understanding of
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will the EDR under normal driving conditions and no perassist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems per- sonal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location)
formed. The EDR is designed to record data related to are recorded. However, other parties, such as law envehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of forcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle personally identifying data routinely acquired during a
is designed to record such data as:
crash investigation.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating; To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts
In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
were buckled/fastened;
such as law enforcement, that have the special equip• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the ment, can read the information if they have access to the
accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
vehicle or the EDR.
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
times, including babies and children. Every state in the
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
United States, and every Canadian province, requires
that small children ride in proper restraint systems. This NOTE: For additional information, refer to
is the law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.
www.seatcheck.org or call 1–866–SEATCHECK. CanaChildren 12 years or younger should ride properly dian residents should refer to Transport Canada’s webbuckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash site for additional information: http://www.tc.gc.ca/
statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in eng/roadsafety/safedrivers-childsafety-index-53.htm
Child Restraints
the rear seats rather than in the front.
There are different sizes and types of restraints for
children from newborn size to the child almost large
enough for an adult safety belt. Always check the child
seat Owner’s Manual to make sure you have the correct
seat for your child.
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to hold
even an infant on your lap could become so great that
you could not hold the child, no matter how strong you
are. The child and others could be badly injured. Any
child riding in your vehicle should be in a proper
restraint for the child’s size.
2
76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and Toddlers
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large for
Child Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight or Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not reached the
height or weight limits of their child restraint
Children who are at least two years old or
who have out-grown the height or weight
limit of their rear-facing child restraint
Children who have out-grown their
forward-facing child restraint, but are too
small to properly fit the vehicle’s seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger, who
have out-grown the height or weight limit
of their booster seat
Recommended Type of Child Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible
Child Restraint, facing rearward in the rear
seat of the vehicle
Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a
five-point Harness, facing forward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat of the
vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat of
the vehicle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 77
Infants And Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rearwardfacing in the vehicle until they are two years old or until
they reach either the height or weight limit of their rear
facing child safety seat. Two types of child restraints can
be used rearward-facing: infant carriers and convertible
child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rearward-facing in the
vehicle. It is recommended for children from birth until
they reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rearwardfacing or forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child
seats often have a higher weight limit in the rearwardfacing direction than infant carriers do, so they can be
used rearward-facing by children who have outgrown
their infant carrier but are still less than at least two years
old. Children should remain rearward-facing until they
reach the highest weight or height allowed by their
convertible child seat.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear facing infant seat in front of an
air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front Air
Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child 12
years or younger, including a child in a rearward
facing infant seat.
• Only use a rearward-facing child restraint in a rear
seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
2
78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the
forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a
belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts
fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over
the vehicle’s seat cushion while the child’s back is against
the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster
seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held
in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a
collision. The child could be badly injured or
killed. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
directions exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend
over the front of the seat when their back is against the
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 79
seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this 4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching
simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the
the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
vehicle’s seat belt alone:
5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
the vehicle seat?
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check belt fit periof the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the odically. A child’s squirming or slouching can move the
way back?
belt out of position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face
or neck, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle.
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an arm
between their neck and arm?
or behind their back.
2
80 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Recommendations For Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined
Weight of the
Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Use any attachment method shown with an “X” Below
LATCH –
Seat Belt Only
LATCH –
Seat Belt + Top
Lower Anchors
Lower Anchors
Tether Anchor
Only
+ Top Tether
Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
X
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 81
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)
Restraint System
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower
Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system
has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCHequipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages
located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the
seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the
seating position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle’s
seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether
anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating
positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether
anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the
following table for more information.
2
82 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LATCH Positions For Installing Child Restraints In This Vehicle
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per seating
position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 83
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
LATCH anchorage system to attach the child
restraint?
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat belt
be used together to attach a rear-facing or
forward-facing child restraint?
Can a child seat be installed in the center
position using the inner LATCH lower anchorages?
No
Yes
Use the LATCH anchorage system until the
combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt
alone instead of the LATCH anchorage system once the combined weight is more than
65 lbs (29.5 kg).
Do not use the seat belt when you use the
LATCH anchorage system to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint.
You can install child restraints with flexible
lower anchors in the center position. Do not
install child restraints with rigid lower anchors in the center position.
2
84 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Can two child restraints be attached using a
common lower LATCH anchorage?
No
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the
back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
No
Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with two
or more child restraints. If the center position does not have dedicated LATCH lower
anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child
seat in the center position next to a child
seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position.
The child seat may touch the back of the
front passenger seat if the child restraint
manufacturer also allows contact. See your
child restraint owner’s manual for more information.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 85
Locating The LATCH Anchorages
The lower anchorages are round bars that are
found at the rear of the seat cushion where it
meets the seatback, below the anchorage symbols on the seatback. They are just visible when
you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint.
You will easily feel them if you run your finger along gap
between the seatback and seat cushion.
2
Rear Seat LATCH Anchorages
86 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Locating The LATCH Anchorages
In addition, there are tether strap anchorages
behind each rear seating position located in the
panel between the rear seatback and the rear
window. These tether strap anchorages are
under a plastic cover with the tether anchorage symbol
on it.
Tether Strap Anchorages
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side.
Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower
anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the
anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some
rear-facing infant restraints will also be equipped with a
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 87
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end
to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten
the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
Center Seat LATCH
WARNING! (Continued)
seat belt for installing child seats in the outboard
positions. Please refer to “Installing The LATCHCompatible Child Restraint System” for typical installation instructions.
Do not install child restraints with rigid lower attachments in the center seating position. Only install this type
of child restraint in the outboard seating positions. Child Always follow the directions of the child restraint manurestraints with flexible, webbing mounted lower attach- facturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child
restraint systems will be installed as described here.
ments can be installed in any rear seating position.
To Install A LATCH-compatible Child Restraint
WARNING!
Never use the same lower anchorage to attach more
than one child restraint. If you are installing LATCHcompatible child restraints next to each other, you
must use the seat belt for the center position. You can
then use either the LATCH anchors or the vehicle’s
(Continued)
1. If the selected seating position has a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat
belt, following the instructions below. See the section
“Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat
Belt” to check what type of seat belt each seating
position has.
2
88 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the 6. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint
tether strap of the child seat so that you can more
rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack
in the straps according to the child restraint manufaceasily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle
turer’s instructions.
anchorages.
3. Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for 7. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
that seating position. For some second row seats, you
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
may need to recline the seat and / or raise the head
restraint to get a better fit.
in any direction.
4. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child How To Stow An Unused ALR Seatbelt
restraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seat- When using the LATCH attaching system to install a
ing position.
child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being
5. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the used by other occupants or being used to secure child
top tether anchorage. See the section “Installing Child restraints. An unused belt could injure a child if they play
Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for direc- with it and accidentally lock the seatbelt retractor. Before
installing a child restraint using the LATCH system,
tions to attach a tether anchor.
buckle the seat belt behind the child restraint and out of
the child’s reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with
the child restraint installation, instead of buckling it
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 89
behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the
child restraint belt path and then buckle it. Do not lock
the seatbelt. Remind all children in the vehicle that the
seat belts are not toys and that they should not play with
them.
WARNING!
Improper installation of a child restraint to the
LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the restraint. The child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or child restraint.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with either a Switchable Automatic Locking
Retractor (ALR) or a cinching latch plate or both. Both
types of seat belts are designed to keep the lap portion of
the seat belt tight around the child restraint so that it is
not necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can
be “switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. For additional information on ALR,
refer to the “Automatic Locking Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints.” The cinching latch plate is
designed to hold the lap portion of the seatbelt tight
when webbing is pulled tight and straight through a
child restraint’s belt path. Please see the table below and
the following sections for more information about both
types of seat belts.
2
90 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems for Installing Child Restraints in this Vehicle
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
Tether Anchor with the seat belt to attach a
forward facing child restraint?
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
The Tether Anchor can be used with the seat belt
until the combined weight of the child and the
child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt
without the Tether Anchor once the combined
weight is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 91
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the
back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten the
seat belt against the belt path of the child
restraint?
No
Yes
Installing A Child Restraint with a Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
Contact between the front passenger seat and
the child restraint is allowed, if the child
restraint manufacturer also allows contact.
2
In positions with cinching latch plates
(CINCH), the buckle stalk may be twisted up
to 3 full turns. Do not twist the buckle stalk in
a seating position with an ALR retractor.
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
“click.”
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating 4. Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
against the child seat.
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a
better fit.
2. Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
92 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of 8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you
strap. Refer to “Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) Restraint System” for directions to
will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is
now in the Automatic Locking mode.
attach a tether anchor.
6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is 9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webpulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
lap portion around the child restraint while you push Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
the child restraint rearward and downward into the belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
vehicle seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 93
4. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
lap portion around the child restraint while you push
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating
vehicle seat.
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
recline the seat and / or raise the head restraint to get 5. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
a better fit.
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
2. Next, pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the
strap. Refer to “Lower Anchors and Tethers for Chilretractor to pass it through the belt path of the child
dren (LATCH) Restraint System” for directions to
restraint. Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt
attach a tether anchor.
path.
6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
“click.”
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
Installing A Child Restraint With A Cinching
Latch Plate (CINCH) — If Equipped
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
2
94 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the buckle or the cinching latch plate is too close to the Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
belt path opening of the child restraint, you may have Anchorage
trouble tightening the seat belt. If this happens, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle and twist the short
1. Look behind the seating position where you
buckle-end belt up to three full turns to shorten it. Insert
plan to install the child restraint to find the
the latch plate into the buckle with the release button
tether anchorage. You may need to move the
facing out, away from the child restraint. Repeat steps 4
seat forward to provide better access to the
to 6, above, to complete the installation of the child
tether anchorage. If there is no top tether anchorage for
restraint.
that seating position (see the charts above), move the
If the belt still cannot be tightened after you shorten the child restraint to another position in the vehicle if one is
buckle, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle, turn available.
the buckle around one half turn, and insert the latch plate
2. Rotate or lift the cover to access the anchor directly
into the buckle again. If you still cannot make the child
behind the seat where you are placing the child
restraint installation tight, try a different seating position.
restraint.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 95
3. Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path
for the strap between the anchor and the child seat. If
your vehicle is equipped with adjustable rear head
restraints, raise the head restraint, and where possible,
route the tether strap under the head restraint and
between the two posts. If not possible, lower the head
restraint and pass the tether strap around the outboard
side of the head restraint.
2
Tether Strap Mounting
1 — Cover
3 — Attaching Strap
A — Tether Strap Hook
B — Tether Anchor
4. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to
the top tether anchorage as shown in the diagram.
96 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within the
limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good break-in.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
Wide-open throttle acceleration in low gear can be detriTransporting Pets
mental and should be avoided.
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a
An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly
high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil
injured, or injure a passenger during panic braking or in
changes should be consistent with anticipated climate
a collision.
conditions under which vehicle operations will occur. For
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses the recommended viscosity and quality grades, refer to
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
“Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle”.
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
A long break-in period is not required for the engine and
drivetrain (transmission and axle) in your vehicle.
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km).
After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or
55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable.
CAUTION!
Never use Non-Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral Oil
in the engine or damage may result.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 97
NOTE: A new engine may consume some oil during its
first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This
should be considered a normal part of the break-in and
not interpreted as an indication of difficulty.
SAFETY TIPS
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
Exhaust Gas
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon
monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can
(Continued)
2
98 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO),
follow these safety tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in
confined areas any longer than needed to move
your vehicle in or out of the area.
• If you are required to drive with the trunk/liftgate
open, make sure that all windows are closed and
the climate control BLOWER switch is set at high
speed. DO NOT use the recirculation mode.
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running, adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the vehicle. Set the
blower at high speed.
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust
system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the
vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is
damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,
damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open
seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,
inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle
Seat Belts
Inspect the belt system periodically, checking for cuts,
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system.
system.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 99
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after
a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor,
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding belt
or retractor condition, replace the belt.
feel the air directed against the windshield. See your
authorized dealer for service if your defroster is inoperable.
2
Floor Mat Safety Information
Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your
vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area
unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they
The light should come on and remain on for cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals
four to eight seconds as a bulb check when the or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
ignition switch is first turned ON. If the light is
not lit during starting, see your authorized
WARNING!
dealer. If the light stays on, flickers, or comes on while
driving, have the system checked by an authorized Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of
vehicle control and increase the risk of serious perdealer.
sonal injury.
Defroster
• Always make sure that floor mats are properly
attached to the floor mat fasteners.
Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place
the blower control on high speed. You should be able to
Air Bag Warning Light
(Continued)
100 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never place or install floor mats or other floor
coverings in the vehicle that cannot be properly
secured to prevent them from moving and interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the
vehicle.
• Never put floor mats or other floor coverings on top
of already installed floor mats. Additional floor
mats and other coverings will reduce the size of the
pedal area and interfere with the pedals.
• Check mounting of mats on a regular basis. Always
properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have
been removed for cleaning.
• Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the
driver footwell while the vehicle is moving. Objects can become trapped under the brake pedal
and accelerator pedal causing a loss of vehicle
control.
• If required, mounting posts must be properly installed, if not equipped from the factory.
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or
mounting can cause interference with the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal operation causing loss of
control of the vehicle.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 101
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
Door Latches
Tires
Fluid Leaks
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects
lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts
and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and bulges.
Check the wheel nuts for tightness. Check the tires
(including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,
engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline
fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid, or
brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause should be
located and corrected immediately.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Check for positive closing, latching, and locking.
2
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
▫ Phone Call Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
▫ Uconnect威 Phone Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .108
▫ Advanced Phone Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . .129
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Things You Should Know About Your
Uconnect威 Phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
▫ Adjusting Side View Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .111
▫ Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped . . .111
䡵 Uconnect威 Phone — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . .111
▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
䡵 VOICE COMMAND — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . .142
▫ Voice Command System Operation . . . . . . . . .142
▫ Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
▫ Voice Training . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
3
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Power Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
▫ Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
▫ Headlights And Parking Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .165
▫ Manual Front Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . .153
▫ Automatic Headlights — If Equipped . . . . . . .165
▫ Driver Seat Manual Height Adjuster — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Headlight Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
▫ Reclining Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Lumbar Support — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Fold-Flat Passenger Seatback . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
▫ Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
▫ Folding Rear Seat Center Armrest . . . . . . . . .161
䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD . . . . . . . . .162
▫ Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ High/Low Beam Switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
▫ Daytime Running Lights — If Equipped . . . . .168
▫ Instrument Panel Dimmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
▫ Map/Reading/Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .169
▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
▫ Battery Saver Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .171
▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
▫ Intermittent Wiper System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 䡵 GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED. . . .179
▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
▫ Before You Begin Programming HomeLink威. . .181
▫ Mist Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
▫ Programming A Rolling Code . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
▫ Headlights With Wipers Feature (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
▫ Programming A Non-Rolling Code . . . . . . . . .184
䡵 TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN . . .175
䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
▫ To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
▫ Canadian/Gate Operator Programming . . . . . .185
▫ Using HomeLink威 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
▫ Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
▫ Troubleshooting Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
䡵 POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .189
3
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Opening Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190 䡵 CUPHOLDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
▫ Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . .190
▫ Front Seat Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
▫ Closing Sunroof — Express. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
▫ Rear Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
▫ Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . .190 䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
▫ Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
▫ Glovebox Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . .198
▫ Venting Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191 䡵 CONSOLE FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
▫ Sunshade Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
▫ Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191 䡵 CARGO AREA FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
▫ Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
▫ Ski Pass-Through. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
▫ Ignition Off Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192 䡵 REAR WINDOW FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
䡵 ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . .192
䡵 CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
▫ Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
MIRRORS
Inside Day/Night Mirror
A two-point pivot system allows for horizontal and
vertical mirror adjustment. Adjust the mirror to center on
the view through the rear window.
3
Headlight glare can be reduced by moving the small
control under the mirror to the night position (toward the
rear of the vehicle). The mirror should be adjusted while
set in the day position (toward the windshield).
Adjusting Rearview Mirror
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare
from vehicles behind you. You can turn the feature on or
off by pressing the button at the base of the mirror. A light
to the left of the button will illuminate to indicate when
the dimming feature is activated. The sensor to the right
of the button does not illuminate.
NOTE: This feature is disabled when the vehicle is
moving in reverse.
Automatic Dimming Mirror
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, never
spray any cleaning solution directly onto the mirror.
Apply the solution onto a clean cloth and wipe the
mirror clean.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109
Power Mirrors
The power mirror control is located on the driver’s door
trim panel.
3
Mirror Directions
Power Mirror Control
To adjust a mirror, turn the control wand toward the left
or right mirror positions indicated. Tilt the control wand
in the direction you want the mirror to move.
When you are finished adjusting the mirror, turn the
control to the center position to prevent accidentally
moving a mirror.
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Adjusting Side View Mirrors
WARNING! (Continued)
Outside Mirror — Driver Side
Adjust the outside mirror to center on the adjacent lane of
traffic, with a slight overlap of the view obtained on the
inside mirror.
Outside Mirror — Passenger Side
collide with another vehicle or other object. Use your
inside mirror when judging the size or distance of a
vehicle seen in the passenger side convex mirror.
Some vehicles will not have a convex passenger side
mirror.
Adjust the convex outside mirror so you can just see the Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature
side of your vehicle in the part of the mirror closest to the All exterior mirrors are hinged and may be moved either
vehicle.
forward or rearward to resist damage. The hinges have
three detent positions: full forward, full rearward and
WARNING!
normal.
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side convex mirror could cause you to
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111
Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This
feature is activated whenever you turn on the rear
window defroster. Refer to “Rear Window Features” in
“Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
3
Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped
An illuminated vanity mirror is on each sun visor. To use
the mirror, lower the sun visor and rotate the mirror
cover upward. The lights will turn on automatically.
Closing the mirror cover turns off the lights.
Illuminated Vanity Mirror
Uconnect姞 Phone — IF EQUIPPED
Uconnect威 Phone is a voice-activated, hands-free, in-vehicle
communications system. Uconnect威 Phone allows you to
dial a phone number with your mobile phone using simple
voice commands (e.g., “Call” ѧ “Mike” ѧ “Work” or “Dial”
ѧ “248-555-1212”). Your mobile phone’s audio is transmitted
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
through your vehicle’s audio system; the system will auto- without wires or a docking station, so Uconnect威 Phone
matically mute your radio when using the Uconnect威 works no matter where you stow your mobile phone (be
it your purse, pocket, or briefcase), as long as your phone
Phone.
is turned on and has been paired to the vehicle’s
NOTE: The Uconnect威 Phone requires a mobile phone
Uconnect威 Phone. The Uconnect威 Phone allows up to
equipped with the Bluetooth威 “Hands-Free Profile”, Verseven mobile phones to be linked to the system. Only one
sion 0.96 or higher. See the Uconnect威 website for suplinked (or paired) mobile phone can be used with the
ported phones.
system at a time. The system is available in English,
For Uconnect威 customer support, visit
Spanish, or French languages.
www.UconnectPhone.com or call 1–877–855–8400.
Uconnect威 Phone allows you to transfer calls between the
system and your mobile phone as you enter or exit your
vehicle and enables you to mute the system’s microphone
for private conversation.
The Uconnect威 Phone is driven through your Bluetooth威
“Hands-Free Profile” mobile phone. Uconnect威 features
Bluetooth威 technology - the global standard that enables
different electronic devices to connect to each other
WARNING!
Any voice commanded system should be used only
in safe driving conditions following all applicable
laws, including laws regarding phone use. Your attention should be focused on safely operating the
vehicle. Failure to do so may result in a collision
causing serious injury or death.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113
The Uconnect威 Phone is fully integrated with the vehicle’s audio system. The volume of the Uconnect威 Phone
The radio or steering wheel controls (if
can be adjusted either from the radio volume control
equipped) will contain the two control buttons
knob or from the steering wheel radio control (right
button and Voice Com(Uconnect威 Phone
switch), if so equipped.
mand
button) that will enable you to
access the system. When you press the button you will The radio display will be used for visual prompts from
hear the word Uconnect威 followed by a BEEP. The beep the Uconnect威 Phone such as “CELL” or caller ID on
certain radios.
is your signal to give a command.
Uconnect威 Phone Button
Voice Command Button
Operation
Actual button location may vary with the ra- Voice commands can be used to operate the Uconnect威
dio. The individual buttons are described in the Phone and to navigate through the Uconnect威 Phone
menu structure. Voice commands are required after most
“Operation” section.
Uconnect威 Phone prompts. You will be prompted for a
The Uconnect威 Phone can be used with any Hands-Free specific command and then guided through the available
Profile certified Bluetooth威 mobile phone. See the options.
Uconnect威 website for supported phones. Refer to your
mobile service provider or the phone manufacturer for
details.
3
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• Prior to giving a voice command, one must wait for the Voice Command Tree
beep, which follows the “Ready” prompt or another Refer to “Voice Tree” in this section.
prompt.
Help Command
• For certain operations, compound commands can be
used. For example, instead of saying “Setup” and then If you need assistance at any prompt, or if you want to
“Pair a Device”, the following compound command know your options at any prompt, say “Help” following
the beep. The Uconnect威 Phone will play some of the
can be said: “Pair a Bluetooth威 Device”.
options at any prompt if you ask for help.
• For each feature explanation in this section, only the
compound form of the voice command is given. You To activate the Uconnect威 Phone, simply press the
button and follow the audible prompts for directions.
can also break the commands into parts and say each
part of the command when you are asked for it. For Uconnect威 Phone sessions begin with a press of the
button on the radio control head.
example, you can use the compound form voice command “Phonebook New Entry”, or you can break the Cancel Command
compound form command into two voice commands:
“Phonebook” and “New Entry”. Please remember, the At any prompt, after the beep, you can say “Cancel” and
Uconnect威 Phone works best when you talk in a you will be returned to the main menu. However, in a
normal conversational tone, as if speaking to someone few instances the system will take you back to the
previous menu.
sitting a few feet/meters away from you.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115
Pair (Link) Uconnect威 Phone To A Mobile Phone
To begin using your Uconnect威 Phone, you must pair
your compatible Bluetooth威 enabled mobile phone.
To complete the pairing process, you will need to reference your mobile phone Owner’s Manual. The
Uconnect威 website may also provide detailed instructions for pairing.
The following are general phone to Uconnect威 Phone
pairing instructions:
• Press the
button to begin.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Device Pairing”.
• When prompted, after the beep, say “Pair a Device”
and follow the audible prompts.
• You will be asked to say a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN), which you will later need to
enter into your mobile phone. You can enter any
four-digit PIN. You will not need to remember this PIN
after the initial pairing process.
• For identification purposes, you will be prompted to
give the Uconnect威 Phone a name for your mobile
phone. Each mobile phone that is paired should be
given a unique phone name.
• You will then be asked to give your mobile phone a
priority level between one and seven, with one being
the highest priority. You can pair up to seven mobile
phones to your Uconnect威 Phone. However, at any
given time, only one mobile phone can be in use,
connected to your Uconnect威 System. The priority
allows the Uconnect威 Phone to know which mobile
phone to use if multiple mobile phones are in the
vehicle at the same time. For example, if priority three
and priority five phones are present in the vehicle, the
Uconnect威 Phone will use the priority three mobile
3
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
phone when you make a call. You can select to use a • After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Call”.
lower priority mobile phone at any time (refer to
“Advanced Phone Connectivity” in this section).
• The system will prompt you to say the name of the
person you want to call.
Dial By Saying A Number
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
the name of the person you want to call. For example,
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
you can say “John Doe”, where John Doe is a previ“Dial”.
ously stored name entry in the Uconnect威 phonebook
or downloaded phonebook. To learn how to store a
• The system will prompt you to say the number you
name in the phonebook, refer to “Add Names to Your
want to call.
Uconnect威 Phonebook”, in the phonebook.
• For example, you can say “234-567-8901”.
• The Uconnect威 system will confirm the name and then
• The Uconnect威 Phone will confirm the phone number
dial the corresponding phone number, which may
and then dial. The number will appear in the display
appear in the display of certain radios.
of certain radios.
Add Names To Your Uconnect威 Phonebook
Call By Saying A Name
NOTE: Adding names to the Uconnect威 Phonebook is
• Press the
button to begin.
recommended when the vehicle is not in motion.
• Press the
button to begin.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117
• Press the
button to begin.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Phonebook New Entry”.
• When prompted, say the name of the new entry. Use of
long names helps the Voice Command and it is recommended. For example, say “Robert Smith” or “Robert”
instead of “Bob”.
• When prompted, enter the number designation (e.g.,
“Home”, “Work”, “Mobile”, or “Other”). This will
allow you to store multiple numbers for each phonebook entry, if desired.
The Uconnect威 Phone will allow you to enter up to 32
names in the phonebook with each name having up to
four associated phone numbers and designations. Each
language has a separate 32-name phonebook accessible
only in that language. In addition, if equipped and
supported by your phone, Uconnect威 Phone automatically downloads your mobile phone’s phonebook.
Phonebook Download – Automatic Phonebook
Transfer From Mobile Phone
If equipped and specifically supported by your phone,
Uconnect威 Phone automatically downloads names (text
names) and number entries from your mobile phone’s
• When prompted, recite the phone number for the phonebook. Specific Bluetooth威 Phones with Phone Book
Access Profile may support this feature. See Uconnect威
phonebook entry that you are adding.
website for supported phones.
After you are finished adding an entry into the phonebook, you will be given the opportunity to add more • To call a name from the Uconnect威 Phonebook or
downloaded Phonebook, follow the procedure in “Call
phone numbers to the current entry or to return to the
by Saying a Name” section.
main menu.
3
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• Automatic download and update, if supported, begins • This downloaded phonebook cannot be edited or
as soon as the Bluetooth威 wireless phone connection is
deleted on the Uconnect威 Phone. These can only be
edited on the mobile phone. The changes are transmade to the Uconnect威 Phone, for example, after you
ferred and updated to Uconnect威 Phone on the next
start the vehicle.
phone connection.
• A maximum of 1000 entries per phone will be downloaded and updated every time a phone is connected Edit Uconnect威 Phonebook Entries
to the Uconnect威 Phone.
NOTE:
• Depending on the maximum number of entries down• Editing names in the phonebook is recommended
loaded, there may be a short delay before the latest
when the vehicle is not in motion.
downloaded names can be used. Until then, if available, the previously downloaded phonebook is avail- • Automatic downloaded phonebook entries cannot be
deleted or edited.
able for use.
• Only the phonebook of the currently connected mobile •
phone is accessible.
•
• Either the mobile phone’s phonebook or the mobile
phone’s SIM card phonebook is downloaded.
•
Press the
button to begin.
After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Phonebook Edit Entry”.
You will then be asked for the name of the phonebook
entry that you wish to edit.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119
• Next, choose the number designation (home, work, •
mobile, or other) that you wish to edit.
•
• When prompted, recite the new phone number for the
phonebook entry that you are editing.
•
After you are finished editing an entry in the phonebook,
you will be given the opportunity to edit another entry in
the phonebook, call the number you just edited, or return
to the main menu.
Press the
button to begin.
After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Phonebook Delete”.
After you enter the Phonebook Delete menu, you will
then be asked for the name of the entry that you wish to
delete. You can either say the name of a phonebook entry
that you wish to delete or you can say “List Names” to
hear a list of the entries in the phonebook from which
you choose. To select one of the entries from the list, press
the
button while the Uconnect威 Phone is playing
the desired entry and say “Delete”.
“Phonebook Edit Entry” can be used to add another
phone number to a name entry that already exists in the
phonebook. For example, the entry John Doe may have a
mobile and a home number, but you can add “John • After you enter the name, the Uconnect威 Phone will
ask you which designation you wish to delete: home,
Doe’s” work number later using the “Phonebook Edit
work, mobile, other, or all. Say the designation you
Entry” feature.
wish to delete.
Delete Uconnect威 Phonebook Entry
• Note that only the phonebook entry in the current
NOTE: Editing phonebook entries is recommended
language is deleted.
when the vehicle is not in motion.
3
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• Automatic downloaded phonebook entries cannot be List All Names In The Uconnect威 Phonebook
deleted or edited.
• Press the
button to begin.
Delete/Erase “All” Uconnect威 Phonebook Entries
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
• Press the
button to begin.
“Phonebook List Names”.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say • The Uconnect威 Phone will play the names of all the
“Phonebook Erase All”.
phonebook entries, including the downloaded phonebook entries, if available.
• The Uconnect威 Phone will ask you to verify that you
butwish to delete all the entries from the phonebook.
• To call one of the names in the list, press the
ton during the playing of the desired name, and say
• After confirmation, the phonebook entries will be
“Call”.
deleted.
NOTE: The user can also exercise “Edit” or “Delete”
• Note that only the phonebook in the current language
operations at this point.
is deleted.
• The Uconnect威 Phone will then prompt you as to the
• Automatic downloaded phonebook entries cannot be
number designation you wish to call.
deleted or edited.
• The selected number will be dialed.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121
Answer Or Reject An Incoming Call — Call
The following features can be accessed through the Currently In Progress
Uconnect威 Phone if the feature(s) are available on your If a call is currently in progress and you have another
mobile service plan. For example, if your mobile service incoming call, you will hear the same network tones for
plan provides three-way calling, this feature can be call waiting that you normally hear when using your
button to place the current
accessed through the Uconnect威 Phone. Check with your mobile phone. Press the
call on hold and answer the incoming call.
mobile service provider for the features that you have.
Phone Call Features
NOTE: The Uconnect威 Phone compatible phones in the
market today do not support rejecting an incoming call
When you receive a call on your mobile phone, the when another call is in progress. Therefore, the user can
Uconnect威 Phone will interrupt the vehicle audio system, only answer an incoming call or ignore it.
if on, and will ask if you would like to answer the call. Making A Second Call While Current Call Is In
button to accept the call. To reject the call, Progress
Press the
button until you hear a single beep,
press and hold the
To make a second call while you are currently on a call,
indicating that the incoming call was rejected.
press the
button and say “Dial” or “Call” followed
by the phone number or phonebook entry you wish to
call. The first call will be on hold while the second call is
Answer Or Reject An Incoming Call — No Call
Currently In Progress
3
122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
in progress. To go back to the first call, refer to “Toggling Conference Call
Between Calls” in this section. To combine two calls, refer When two calls are in progress (one active and one on
to “Conference Call” in this section.
button until you hear a
hold), press and hold the
double beep indicating that the two calls have been
Place/Retrieve A Call From Hold
joined into one conference call.
To put a call on hold, press the
button until you hear
a single beep. This indicates that the call is on hold. To Three-Way Calling
but- To initiate three-way calling, press the
bring the call back from hold, press and hold the
button while
ton until you hear a single beep.
a call is in progress, and make a second phone call, as
described under “Making a Second Call While Current
Call is in Progress”. After the second call has established,
If two calls are in progress (one active and one on hold),
button until you hear a double
press and hold the
press the
button until you hear a single beep, indicatbeep, indicating that the two calls have been joined into
ing that the active and hold status of the two calls have
one conference call.
switched. Only one call can be placed on hold at a time.
Toggling Between Calls
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123
Call Termination
To end a call in progress, momentarily press the
button. Only the active call(s) will be terminated and if there
is a call on hold, it will become the new active call. If the
active call is terminated by the phone far end, a call on
hold may not become active automatically. This is cell
phone-dependent. To bring the call back from hold, press
button until you hear a single beep.
and hold the
Redial
NOTE: This may not be the last number dialed from the
Uconnect威 Phone.
Call Continuation
Call continuation is the progression of a phone call on the
Uconnect威 Phone after the vehicle ignition has been
switched to OFF. Call continuation functionality available on the vehicle can be any one of three types:
• After the ignition is switched to OFF, a call can
continue on the Uconnect威 Phone either until the call
ends, or until the vehicle battery condition dictates
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
cessation of the call on the Uconnect威 Phone and
“Redial”.
transfer of the call to the mobile phone.
• The Uconnect威 Phone will call the last number that
• After the ignition is cycled to OFF, a call can continue
was dialed from your mobile phone.
on the Uconnect威 Phone for a certain duration, after
which the call is automatically transferred from the
Uconnect威 Phone to the mobile phone.
• Press the
button to begin.
3
124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• An active call is automatically transferred to the mo- NOTE: After every Uconnect威 Phone language change
operation, only the language-specific 32-name phonebile phone after the ignition is cycled to OFF.
book is usable. The paired phone name is not languageUconnect姞 Phone Features
specific and is usable across all languages.
Language Selection
Emergency Assistance
To change the language that the Uconnect威 Phone is
If you are in an emergency and the mobile phone is
using:
reachable:
button to begin.
• Press the
• Pick up the phone and manually dial the emergency
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
number for your area.
the name of the language you wish to switch to
If the phone is not reachable and the Uconnect威 Phone is
English, Espanol, or Francais.
operational, you may reach the emergency number as
• Continue to follow the system prompts to complete the follows:
language selection.
button to begin.
• Press the
After selecting one of the languages, all prompts and
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
voice commands will be in that language.
“Emergency” and the Uconnect威 Phone will instruct the
paired mobile phone to call the emergency number. This
feature is supported in the U.S., Canada, and Mexico.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125
NOTE:
• The emergency number dialed is based on the country
where the vehicle is purchased (911 for the U.S. and
Canada and 060 for Mexico). The number dialed may
not be applicable with the available mobile service and
area.
WARNING!
To use you Uconnect威 Phone System in an emergency, your mobile phone must be:
• turned on,
• paired to the Uconnect威 System,
• and have network coverage.
• If supported, this number may be programmable on
button and say Roadside Assistance
some systems. To do this, press the
“Setup”, followed by “Emergency”.
If you need roadside assistance:
• The Uconnect威 Phone does slightly lower your • Press the
button to begin.
chances of successfully making a phone call as to that
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
for the mobile phone directly.
“Roadside Assistance”.
3
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
Voice Mail Calling
• The roadside assistance number dialed is based on the
country where the vehicle is purchased (1-800-5282069 for the U.S., 1-877-213-4525 for Canada, 55-143454 for Mexico City and 1-800-712-3040 for outside
Mexico City in Mexico). Please refer to the “Roadside
Assistance” coverage details on the DVD in the Warranty Information Booklet and the Roadside Assistance references.
To learn how to access your voice mail, refer to “Working
with Automated Systems”.
Working With Automated Systems
This method is used in instances where one generally has
to press numbers on the mobile phone keypad while
navigating through an automated telephone system.
You can use your Uconnect威 Phone to access a voice mail
• If supported, this number may be programmable on system or an automated service, such as a paging service
button and say or automated customer service line. Some services resome systems. To do this, press the
quire immediate response selection. In some instances,
“Setup”, followed by “Roadside Assistance”.
that may be too quick for use of the Uconnect威 Phone.
Paging
When calling a number with your Uconnect威 Phone that
To learn how to page, refer to “Working with Automated
normally requires you to enter in a touch-tone sequence
Systems”. Paging works properly except for pagers of
on your mobile phone keypad, you can press the
certain companies, which time out a little too soon to
button and say the sequence you wish to enter,
work properly with the Uconnect威 Phone.
followed by the word “Send”. For example, if required to
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
enter your PIN followed with a pound, (3 7 4 6 #), you • Some paging and voice mail systems have system time
out settings that are too short and may not allow the
button and say, “3 7 4 6 # Send”.
can press the
use of this feature.
Saying a number, or sequence of numbers, followed by
“Send”, is also to be used for navigating through an
Barge In — Overriding Prompts
automated customer service center menu structure, and
The “Voice Command” button can be used when you
to leave a number on a pager.
wish to skip part of a prompt and issue your voice
You can also send stored Uconnect威 phonebook entries as command immediately. For example, if a prompt is
tones for fast and easy access to voice mail and pager asking “Would you like to pair a phone, clear a...,” you
entries. To use this feature, dial the number you wish to could press the
button and say, “Pair a Phone” to
button and say, “Send.” The
call and then press the
select that option without having to listen to the rest of
system will prompt you to enter the name or number and
the voice prompt.
say the name of the phonebook entry you wish to send.
The Uconnect威 Phone will then send the corresponding Turning Confirmation Prompts ON/OFF
phone number associated with the phonebook entry, as Turning confirmation prompts off will stop the system
tones over the phone.
from confirming your choices (e.g., the Uconnect威 Phone
NOTE:
will not repeat a phone number before you dial it).
• You may not hear all of the tones due to mobile phone • Press the
network configurations. This is normal.
button to begin.
3
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say dialing a number with your paired Bluetooth威 mobile
phone, the audio will be played through your vehicle’s
one of the following:
audio system. The Uconnect威 Phone will work the same
– “Setup Confirmation Prompts On”
as if you dial the number using Voice Command.
– “Setup Confirmation Prompts Off”
NOTE: Certain brands of mobile phones do not send the
Phone And Network Status Indicators
dial ring to the Uconnect威 Phone to play it on the vehicle
If available on the radio and/or on a premium display audio system, so you will not hear it. Under this situasuch as the instrument panel cluster, and supported by tion, after successfully dialing a number the user may feel
your mobile phone, the Uconnect威 Phone will provide that the call did not go through even though the call is in
notification to inform you of your phone and network progress. Once your call is answered, you will hear the
status when you are attempting to make a phone call audio.
using Uconnect威 Phone. The status is given for network Mute/Un-Mute (Mute ON/OFF)
signal strength, phone battery strength, etc.
When you mute the Uconnect威 Phone, you will still be
Dialing Using The Mobile Phone Keypad
able to hear the conversation coming from the other
You can dial a phone number with your mobile phone party, but the other party will not be able to hear you. In
keypad and still use the Uconnect威 Phone (while dialing order to mute the Uconnect威 Phone:
via the mobile phone keypad, the user must exercise • Press the
button.
caution and take precautionary safety measures). By
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
• Following the beep, say “Mute”.
In order to un-mute the Uconnect威 Phone:
• Press the
button.
• Following the beep, say “Mute off”.
Connect Or Disconnect Link Between The
Uconnect威 Phone And Mobile Phone
Your mobile phone can be paired with many different
electronic devices, but can only be actively “connected”
with one electronic device at a time.
If you would like to connect or disconnect the Bluetooth威
connection between your mobile phone and the
Transfer Call To And From Mobile Phone
Uconnect威 Phone System, follow the instructions deThe Uconnect威 Phone allows ongoing calls to be trans- scribed in your mobile phone User’s Manual.
ferred from your mobile phone to the Uconnect威 Phone
List Paired Mobile Phone Names
without terminating the call. To transfer an ongoing call
button to begin.
from your Uconnect威 Phone paired mobile phone to the • Press the
button and
Uconnect威 Phone or vice versa, press the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
say “Transfer Call”.
“Setup Phone Pairing”.
Advanced Phone Connectivity
• When prompted, say “List Phones”.
3
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• The Uconnect威 Phone will play the phone names of all • The selected phone will be used for the next phone
call. If the selected phone is not available, the
paired mobile phones in order from the highest to the
Uconnect威 Phone will return to using the highest
lowest priority. To “Select” or “Delete” a paired phone
priority phone present in or near (approximately
button and say “Sebeing announced, press the
within 30 ft (9 m)) the vehicle.
lect” or “Delete”. Also, see the next two sections for an
alternate way to “Select” or “Delete” a paired phone.
Delete Uconnect威 Phone Paired Mobile Phones
Select Another Mobile Phone
• Press the
button to begin.
This feature allows you to select and start using another
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
phone paired with the Uconnect威 Phone.
“Setup Phone Pairing”.
button to begin.
• Press the
• At the next prompt, say “Delete” and follow the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
prompts.
“Setup Select Phone” and follow the prompts.
button at any time while the
• You can also press the
button at any time while the
• You can also press the
list is being played, and then choose the phone you
list is being played, and then choose the phone that
wish to delete.
you wish to select.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
Things You Should Know About Your Uconnect姞
Phone
Uconnect威 Phone Tutorial
• Press the
button and say the “Voice Training”,
“System Training”, or “Start Voice Training” command.
To hear a brief tutorial of the system features, press the You can either press the Uconnect威 Phone button to
restore the factory setting or repeat the words and
button and say “Uconnect威 Tutorial.”
phrases when prompted by the Uconnect威 Phone. For
Voice Training
best results, the Voice Training session should be comFor users experiencing difficulty with the system recog- pleted when the vehicle is parked with the engine
nizing their voice commands or numbers, the Uconnect威 running, all windows closed, and the blower fan
Phone Voice Training feature may be used. To enter this switched off.
training mode, follow one of the two following proce- This procedure may be repeated with a new user. The
dures:
system will adapt to the last trained voice only.
From outside the Uconnect威 Phone mode (e.g., from Reset
radio mode):
• Press the
button.
button for five seconds until
• Press and hold the
• After the “Ready” prompt, and the following beep, say
the session begins, or,
“Setup”, then “Reset”.
3
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
This will delete all phone pairing, phone book entries,
and other settings in all language modes. The System will
prompt you before resetting to factory settings.
Voice Command
• low road noise,
• smooth road surface,
• fully closed windows,
• dry weather condition.
• For best performance, adjust the rearview mirror to • Even though the system is designed for users speaking
provide at least ½ in (1 cm) gap between the overhead
in North American English, French, and Spanish acconsole (if equipped) and the mirror.
cents, the system may not always work for some.
• Always wait for the beep before speaking.
• When navigating through an automated system such
as voice mail, or when sending a page, at the end of
• Speak normally, without pausing, just as you would
speaking the digit string, make sure to say “Send”.
speak to a person sitting a few feet/meters away from
you.
• Storing names in the phonebook when the vehicle is
not in motion is recommended.
• Make sure that no one other than you is speaking
during a Voice Command period.
• It is not recommended to store similar sounding names
in the Uconnect威 Phonebook.
• Performance is maximized under:
• low-to-medium blower setting,
• low-to-medium vehicle speed,
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133
• Phonebook (Downloaded and Uconnect威 Phone Local) name recognition rate is optimized when the
entries are not similar.
• Numbers must be spoken in single digits. “800” must
be spoken “eight-zero-zero” not “eight hundred”.
• You can say “O” (letter “O”) for “0” (zero).
• smooth road surface,
• fully closed windows,
• dry weather conditions, and
• operation from the driver’s seat.
• Performance, such as audio clarity, echo, and loudness
to a large degree rely on the phone and network, and
not the Uconnect威 Phone.
• Even though international dialing for most number
combinations is supported, some shortcut dialing • Echo at the phone far end can sometimes be reduced
by lowering the in-vehicle audio volume.
number combinations may not be supported.
• In a convertible vehicle, system performance may be • In a convertible vehicle, system performance may be
compromised with the convertible top down.
compromised with the convertible top down.
Far End Audio Performance
Recent Calls
• Audio quality is maximized under:
• low-to-medium blower setting,
• low-to-medium vehicle speed,
• low road noise,
If your phone supports “Automatic Phonebook Download”, Uconnect威 Phone can list your Outgoing, Incoming and Missed Calls.
3
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
SMS
Send Messages:
Uconnect威 Phone can read or send new messages on You can send messages using Uconnect威 Phone. To send
your phone.
a new message:
Read Messages:
• Press the
button.
If you receive a new text message while your phone is • After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
connected to Uconnect威 Phone, an announcement will be
“SMS Send” or “Send Message.”
made to notify you that you have a new text message. If
• You can either say the message you wish to send or say
you wish to hear the new message:
“List Messages.” There are 20 preset messages.
button.
• Press the
button while the
To send a message, press the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say system is listing the message and say “Send.”
“SMS Read” or “Read Messages.”
Uconnect威 Phone will prompt you to say the name or
• Uconnect威 Phone will play the new text message for number of the person you wish to send the message to.
you.
List of Preset Messages:
After reading a message, you can “Reply” or “Forward”
1. Yes
the message using Uconnect威 Phone.
2. No
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
3. Where are you?
16. Can this wait?
4. I need more direction.
17. Bye for now
5. L O L
18. When can we meet?
6. Why
19. Send number to call
7. I love you
20. Start without me
8. Call me
Turn SMS Incoming Announcement ON/OFF
9. Call me later
Turning the SMS Incoming Announcement OFF will stop
the system from announcing the new incoming messages.
10. Thanks
11. See You in 15 minutes
• Press the
12. I am on my way
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Setup, SMS Incoming Message Announcement,” you
will then be given a choice to change it.
13. I’ll be late
14. Are you there yet?
15. Where are we meeting?
button.
3
136 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Bluetooth威 Communication Link
Power-Up
Mobile phones have been found to lose connection to the
Uconnect威 Phone. When this happens, the connection
can generally be reestablished by switching the phone
off/on. Your mobile phone is recommended to remain in
Bluetooth威 ON mode.
After switching the ignition key from OFF to either the
ON or ACC position, or after a language change, you
must wait at least fifteen seconds prior to using the
system.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 137
3
138 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 139
3
140 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
zero
one
two
three
four
five
six
seven
eight
nine
star (*)
plus (+)
pound (#)
add location
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
all
call
cancel
confirmation prompts
continue
delete
dial
download
edit
emergency
English
erase all
Espanol
Francais
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 141
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
help
home
language
list names
list phones
mobile
mute
mute off
new entry
no
other
pair a phone
phone pairing
pairing
phonebook
phone book
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
previous
record again
redial
return to main menu
return or main menu
select phone
select
send
set up
phone settings or phone
set up
towing assistance
transfer call
Uconnect威 Tutorial
voice training
work
yes
3
142 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
General Information
VOICE COMMAND — IF EQUIPPED
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and Voice Command System Operation
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
The Uconnect威 Voice Command system allows
you to control your AM, FM radio, disk player,
• Changes or modifications not expressly approved by
USB mass storage class device, iPOD family of
the party responsible for compliance could void the
devices, Bluetooth Streaming Audio Device,
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
satellite radio, disc player, and a memo recorder.
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
NOTE: Take care to speak into the Voice Interface Sys• This device must accept any interference received,
tem as calmly and normally as possible. The ability of the
including interference that may cause undesired opVoice Interface System to recognize user voice commands
eration.
may be negatively affected by rapid speaking or a raised
voice level.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 143
WARNING!
Any voice commanded system should be used only
in safe driving conditions following all applicable
laws. Your attention should be focused on safely
operating the vehicle. Failure to do so may result in a
collision causing serious injury or death.
Pressing the Voice Command
button while the
system is speaking is known as “barging in.” The system
will be interrupted, and after the beep, you can add or
change commands. This will become helpful once you
start to learn the options.
NOTE: At any time, you can say the words “Cancel”,
“Help” or “Main Menu”.
button, you These commands are universal and can be used from any
When you press the Voice Command
will hear a beep. The beep is your signal to give a menu. All other commands can be used depending upon
command.
the active application.
NOTE: If you do not say a command within a few When using this system, you should speak clearly and at
seconds, the system will present you with a list of a normal speaking volume.
options.
The system will best recognize your speech if the winIf you ever wish to interrupt the system while it lists dows are closed, and the heater/air conditioning fan is
button, listen for set to low.
options, press the Voice Command
the beep, and say your command.
At any point, if the system does not recognize one of your
commands, you will be prompted to repeat it.
3
144 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To hear the first available Menu, press the Voice Com- Main Menu
button and say “Help” or “Main Menu”.
mand
Start a dialogue by pressing the Voice Command
button. You may say “Main Menu” to switch to the
Commands
main menu.
The Voice Command system understands two types of
commands. Universal commands are available at all In this mode, you can say the following commands:
times. Local commands are available if the supported
• “Radio AM” (to switch to the radio AM mode)
radio mode is active.
• “Radio FM” (to switch to radio FM mode)
Changing the Volume
• “Disc” (to switch to the disc mode)
1. Start a dialogue by pressing the Voice Command
button.
• “USB” (to switch to USB mode)
2. Say a command (e.g., “Help”).
• “Bluetooth Streaming” (to switch to Bluetooth威
Streaming mode)
3. Use the ON/OFF VOLUME rotary knob to adjust the
volume to a comfortable level while the Voice Com- • “Memo” (to switch to the memo recorder)
mand system is speaking. Please note the volume
• “System Setup” (to switch to system setup)
setting for Voice Command is different than the audio
system.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 145
Radio AM
• “Menu Radio” (to switch to the radio menu)
To switch to the AM band, say “AM” or “Radio AM”. In • “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
this mode, you may say the following commands:
Satellite Radio
• “Frequency #” (to change the frequency)
To switch to satellite radio mode, say “Sat” or “Satellite
Radio”. In this mode, you may say the following com• “Next Station” (to select the next station)
mands:
• “Previous Station” (to select the previous station)
• “Channel Number” (to change the channel by its
• “Radio Menu” (to switch to the radio menu)
spoken number)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
• “Next Channel” (to select the next channel)
Radio FM
• “Previous Channel” (to select the previous channel)
To switch to the FM band, say “FM” or “Radio FM”. In
• “List Channel” (to hear a list of available channels)
this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Select Name” (to say the name of a channel)
• “Frequency #” (to change the frequency)
• “Next Station” (to select the next station)
• “Menu Radio” (to switch to the radio menu)
• “Previous Station” (to select the previous station)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
3
146 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Disc Mode
Bluetooth威 Streaming (BT) Mode
To switch to the disc mode, say “Disc”. In this mode, you To switch to Bluetooth威 Streaming (BT) mode, say
may say the following commands:
“Bluetooth Streaming”. In this mode, you may say the
following commands:
• “Track” (#) (to change the track)
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
• “List” (to list a Artist, Playlist, Album, Track, etc.)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
Memo Mode
USB Mode
To switch to the voice recorder mode, say “Memo”. In
To switch to USB mode, say “USB”. In this mode, you
this mode, you may say the following commands:
may say the following commands:
• “New Memo” (to record a new memo) — During the
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
recording, you may press the Voice Command
button to stop recording. You proceed by saying
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
one of the following commands:
• “Play” (to play a Artist Name, Playlist Name, Album
– “Save” (to save the memo)
Name, Track Name, etc.)
– “Continue” (to continue recording)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 147
– “Delete” (to delete the recording)
• “Main menu setup” or
• “Play Memos” (to play previously recorded memos) —
During the playback you may press the Voice Combutton to stop playing memos. You promand
ceed by saying one of the following commands:
– “Repeat” (to repeat a memo)
– “Next” (to play the next memo)
– “Previous” (to play the previous memo)
– “Delete” (to delete a memo)
• “Switch to setup”
• “Delete All” (to delete all memos)
• “Voice Training”
In this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Language English”
• “Language French”
• “Language Spanish”
• “Tutorial”
NOTE: Keep in mind that you have to press the Voice
button first and wait for the beep before
Command
To switch to system setup, you may say one of the speaking the “Barge In” commands.
following:
Setup
• “Change to setup”
• “Switch to system setup”
• “Change to setup”
3
148 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Voice Training
SEATS
For users experiencing difficulty with the system recog- Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the
nizing their voice commands or numbers the Uconnect威 vehicle.
Voice “Voice Training” feature may be used.
button, say “System
1. Press the Voice Command
Setup” and once you are in that menu then say “Voice
Training.” This will train your own voice to the system
and will improve recognition.
2. Repeat the words and phrases when prompted by
Uconnect威 Voice. For best results, the “Voice Training”
session should be completed when the vehicle is
parked, engine running, all windows closed, and the
blower fan switched off. This procedure may be repeated with a new user. The system will adapt to the
last trained voice only.
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 149
Power Seats — If Equipped
The power seat switches are located on the outboard side
of the seat near the floor. Use the bottom switch to move
the seat up, down, forward, rearward, or to tilt the seat.
The top switch controls the seatback recliner.
Power Seat Switches
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
3
150 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not place any article under a power seat or
impede its ability to move as it may cause damage to
the seat controls. Seat travel may become limited if
movement is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s
path.
Adjusting The Seat Forward Or Rearward
Tilting The Seat Up Or Down
The angle of the seat cushion can be adjusted in four
directions. Pull upward or push downward on the front
or rear of the seat switch, the front or rear of the seat
cushion will move in the direction of the switch. Release
the switch when the desired position has been reached.
Reclining The Seatback
The angle of the seatback can be adjusted forward or
The seat can be adjusted both forward and rearward. rearward. Push the seatback switch forward or rearward,
Push the seat switch forward or rearward, the seat will the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release
move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch the switch when the desired position is reached.
when the desired position has been reached.
Adjusting The Seat Up Or Down
The height of the seats can be adjusted up or down. Pull
upward or push downward on the seat switch, the seat
will move in the direction of the switch. Release the
switch when the desired position is reached.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 151
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
Do not place any article under a power seat or
impede its ability to move as it may cause damage to
the seat controls. Seat travel may become limited if
movement is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s
path.
Heated Seats — If Equipped
There are two heated seat switches that allow the driver
and passenger to operate the seats independently. The
controls for each heater are located on the center of the
instrument panel (above the climate controls).
3
152 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
You can choose from HIGH, LOW or OFF heat settings. to one, indicating the change. The LOW-level setting will
Amber indicator lights in each switch indicate the level of turn OFF automatically after a maximum of 45 minutes.
heat in use. Two indicator lights will illuminate for
HIGH, one for LOW and none for OFF.
WARNING!
Press the switch once to select HIGH-level
heating. Press the switch a second time to select
LOW-level heating. Press the switch a third
time to shut the heating elements OFF.
NOTE: Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt
within two to five minutes.
When the HIGH-level setting is selected, the heater will
provide a boosted heat level during the first four minutes
of operation. Then, the heat output will drop to the
normal HIGH-level. If the HIGH-level setting is selected,
the system will automatically switch to LOW-level after a
maximum of 60 minutes of continuous operation. At that
time, the number of illuminated LEDs changes from two
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise care
when using the seat heater. It may cause burns
even at low temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat or seatback that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion.
This may cause the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated could cause
serious burns due to the increased surface temperature of the seat.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 153
Pull the bar upward to move the seat forward or rearThe manual seat adjustment bar is at the front of the seat, ward. Release the bar once the seat is in the position
desired. Then, using body pressure, move forward and
near the floor.
rearward on the seat to be sure that the seat adjusters
have latched.
Manual Front Seat Adjustment
WARNING!
Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat could
cause you to lose control. The seat belt might not be
properly adjusted and you could be injured. Adjust
the seat only while the vehicle is parked.
Manual Seat Adjusting Bar
3
154 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Driver Seat Manual Height Adjuster — If
Equipped
Reclining Seats
The recline lever is located on the side of the seat. To
A lever style height adjustment feature enhances comfort recline, lean forward slightly before lifting the lever, then
for petite as well as tall drivers. A lever with a ratcheting lean back to the desired position and release the lever.
mechanism, located on the outboard side of the seat, Lean forward and lift the lever to return the seatback to
its normal position.
raises and lowers it. Total travel is 2.2 in (56 mm).
Seat Height Adjustment Lever
Recline Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 155
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat could
cause you to lose control. The seat belt might not be
properly adjusted and you could be injured. Adjust
the seat only while the vehicle is parked.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your
chest. In a collision you could slide under the seat
belt and be seriously or even fatally injured. Use
the recliner only when the vehicle is parked.
3
Lumbar Support Lever
Lumbar Support — If Equipped
Head Restraints
This feature allows you to increase or decrease the
amount of lumbar support. The control lever is located
on the outboard side of the driver’s seatback. Turn the
control lever downward to increase and upward to
decrease the desired amount of lumbar support.
Head restraints are designed to reduce the risk of injury by
restricting head movement in the event of a rear impact.
Head restraints should be adjusted so that the top of the
head restraint is located above the top of your ear.
156 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
The head restraints for all occupants must be properly adjusted prior to operating the vehicle or occupying a seat. Head restraints should never be adjusted while the vehicle is in motion. Driving a
vehicle with the head restraints improperly adjusted
or removed could cause serious injury or death in the
event of a collision.
When AHRs deploy during a rear impact, the front half
of the head restraint extends forward to minimize the gap
between the back of the occupant’s head and the AHR.
This system is designed to help prevent or reduce the
extent of injuries to the driver and front passenger in
certain types of rear impacts. Refer to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the push
Active Head Restraints — Front Seats
button, located at the base of the head restraint, and push
Active Head Restraints are passive, deployable compo- downward on the head restraint.
nents, and vehicles with this equipment cannot be readily
identified by any markings, only through visual inspection of the head restraint. The head restraint will be split
in two halves, with the front half being soft foam and
trim, the back half being decorative plastic.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 157
3
Push Button
For comfort the Active Head Restraints can be tilted
forward and rearward. To tilt the head restraint closer to
the back of your head, pull forward on the bottom of the
head restraint. Push rearward on the bottom of the head
restraint to move the head restraint away from your
head.
Active Head Restraint (Normal Position)
158 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• In the event of deployment of an Active Head Restraint, refer to “Occupant Restraints/Resetting Active
Head Restraints (AHR)” in “Things to Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
Active Head Restraint (Tilted)
NOTE:
• The head restraints should only be removed by qualified technicians, for service purposes only. If either of
the head restraints require removal, see your authorized dealer.
• Do not place items over the top of the Active Head
Restraint, such as coats, seat covers or portable
DVD players. These items may interfere with the
operation of the Active Head Restraint in the event
of a collision and could result in serious injury or
death.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 159
WARNING! (Continued)
• Active Head Restraints may be deployed if they are
struck by an object such as a hand, foot or loose
cargo. To avoid accidental deployment of the Active Head Restraint ensure that all cargo is secured,
as loose cargo could contact the Active Head Restraint during sudden stops. Failure to follow this
warning could cause personal injury if the Active
Head Restraint is deployed.
Fold-Flat Passenger Seatback
The recline handle on the front passenger seat also
releases the seatback to fold forward.
3
Head Restraints — Rear Seats
The rear seat head restraints are fixed and cannot be
adjusted. For proper routing of a Child Seat Tether refer
to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things to Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
Recline Lever
160 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The hard seatback features a work surface and a molded
rim for retaining items stored on the seatback panel.
Rear Seat Release Loops
Fold-Flat Front Passenger Seat
Folding Rear Seat
To provide additional storage area, the rear seatback can
be folded forward. Pull on the loops to fold down either
or both seatbacks.
When returning the rear seatback to the upright position,
be sure the seatback is latched.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 161
WARNING!
The rear cargo area of the vehicle (with the rear
seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down position)
should not be used as a play area by children. They
could be seriously injured in a collision. Children
should be seated and using the proper restraint
system.
3
Folding Rear Seat Center Armrest
The rear seat is equipped with a folding armrest with
cupholders.
Folding Rear Seat Armrest
162 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
To open the hood, two latches must be released.
2. Then lift the secondary latch located under the front
edge of the hood, near the center and raise the hood.
1. Pull the hood release lever located under the left side
of the instrument panel.
Hood Safety Latch Location
Hood Release Lever
Use the hood prop rod to secure the hood in the open
position. Place the upper end of the prop rod in the hole
on the left underside of the hood.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 163
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to
close it. Use a firm downward push at the center of
the hood to ensure that both latches engage.
3
WARNING!
Prop Rod Location
NOTE: Before closing the hood, make sure to stow the
prop rod in its proper location.
Be sure the hood is fully latched before driving your
vehicle. If the hood is not fully latched, it could open
when the vehicle is in motion and block your vision.
Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
injury or death.
164 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
LIGHTS
Multifunction Lever
The multifunction lever controls the operation of the
parking lights, headlights, headlight beam selection,
passing light, fog lights, instrument panel light dimming
and turn signals. The multifunction lever is located on
the left side of the steering column.
Multifunction Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 165
Headlights And Parking Lights
Automatic Headlights — If Equipped
Turn the end of the multifunction lever to the first detent Turning the end of the multifunction lever to the third
for parking light operation. Turn to the second detent for detent (AUTO), will activate the automatic headlight
headlight operation.
system.
3
Headlight Switch
Headlight Switch
166 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
With the engine running and the multifunction lever in Turn Signals
the AUTO position, the headlights will turn on and turn Move the multifunction lever up or down and the arrows
off based on the surrounding light levels.
on each side of the instrument cluster flash to show
proper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.
Headlight Time Delay
There is also a feature that delays turning off the vehicle
lights for 30, 60 or 90 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned OFF. To activate the headlight delay, the multifunction lever must be rotated to the off position after the
ignition switch is turned OFF. Only the headlights will
illuminate during this time. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC)/Customer-Programmable
Features” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
Lights On Reminder
If the headlights or parking lights are on after the ignition
is turned OFF, a chime will sound to alert the driver
when the driver’s door is opened.
Turn Signal Control
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 167
NOTE: If either light remains on and does not flash, or
there is a very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside
light bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is
moved, it would suggest that the indicator bulb is
defective.
Lane Change Assist
Flash-To-Pass
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by
lightly pulling the multifunction lever toward you. This
will turn on the high beam headlights until the lever is
released.
NOTE: If the multifunction lever is held in the flash-toTap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond pass position for more than 15 seconds, the high beams
the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash will shut off. If this occurs, wait 30 seconds for the next
three times then automatically turn off.
flash-to-pass operation.
High/Low Beam Switch
Push the multifunction lever away from you to switch
the headlights to high beam. Pull the lever toward you, to
switch the headlights back to low beam.
3
168 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Fog Lights — If Equipped
NOTE: The front fog lights will only operate with the
headlights on low beam. Selecting high beam headlights
will turn off the front fog lights.
The front fog light switch is on the multifunction
lever. To activate the front fog lights, turn on the Daytime Running Lights — If Equipped
parking lights or the low beam headlights and pull out
The front turn signal lamps will turn on as Daytime
the end of the multifunction lever.
Running Lights whenever the ignition is ON, the engine
is running, the headlight switch is off, the parking brake
is released and the shift lever is in any position except
PARK.
NOTE: The Daytime Running Lights will flash when a
turn signal is in operation and return to DRL mode when
the turn signal is not operating.
Front Fog Light Operation
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 169
Instrument Panel Dimmer
Rotate the center portion of the lever to the extreme
bottom position to fully dim the instrument panel lights
and prevent the interior lights from illuminating when a
door is opened.
3
Rotate the center portion of the lever up to increase the
brightness of the instrument panel lights when the parking lights or headlights are on.
Rotate the center portion of the lever upward to the next
detent position to brighten the odometer and radio when
the parking lights or headlights are on.
Dimmer Control
Rotate the center portion of the lever upward to the last Map/Reading/Interior Lights
detent to turn on the interior lighting.
These lights are mounted between the sun visors above
the rearview mirror. Each light can be turned on by
pressing the barrel. Press the barrel a second time to turn
the light off. Both of these lights can swivel so that the
light can be aimed at a specific spot, if desired. The lights
170 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
will remain on until the switch is pressed a second time,
so be sure they have been turned off before leaving the
vehicle. They will not turn off automatically. Interior
lighting also comes on when a door is opened or the
dimmer control is turned fully upward, past the second
detent.
There is a second light located midway back in the
headliner.
To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
moved to the LOCK position. This will occur if the
interior lights were switched on manually or are on
because a door is open. To restore interior light operation,
either turn the ignition switch ON or cycle the light
switch.
Battery Saver Feature
To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
moved to the LOCK position. This will occur if the
interior lights were switched on manually or are on
because a door is open.
Map/Reading Lights
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 171
Rotate the end of the lever to the LO position for
low-speed wiper operation, or to the HI position for
The wipers and washers are operated by a switch high-speed wiper operation.
on the control lever. The lever is located on the
right side of the steering column.
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Changing Wiper Speeds
Windshield Wiper/Washer Lever
3
172 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The wipers will automatically return to the park
position if you turn the ignition switch OFF while they
are operating. The wipers will resume operation when
you turn the ignition switch to the ON position again.
CAUTION!
cycles desirable. Rotate the end of the windshield wiper/
washer control lever to the first detent, and then turn the
end of the lever to select the desired delay interval. There
are five delay settings, which allow you to regulate the wipe
interval from a minimum of one cycle every second to a
maximum of approximately 18 seconds between cycles.
• Turn the windshield wipers off when driving
through an automatic car wash. Damage to the
windshield wipers may result if the wiper control
is left in any position other than off.
• Always remove any buildup of snow that prevents
the windshield wiper blades from returning to the
off position. If the windshield wiper control is
turned off and the blades cannot return to the off
position, damage to the wiper motor may occur.
Intermittent Wiper System
Use the intermittent wiper system when weather conditions
make a single wiping cycle with a variable pause between
Changing Intermittent Settings
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 173
NOTE: The wiper delay times depend on vehicle speed.
If the vehicle is moving less than 10 mph (16 km/h),
delay times will be doubled.
Windshield Washers
To use the washer, pull the windshield wiper/washer
control lever toward you and hold it for as long as
washer spray is desired.
WARNING!
Sudden loss of visibility through the windshield
could lead to a collision. You might not see other
vehicles or other obstacles. To avoid sudden icing of
the windshield during freezing weather, warm the
windshield with defroster before and during windshield washer use.
If you activate the washer while the wiper control is in
Mist Feature
the delay range, the wipers will operate in low-speed for
two wipe cycles after releasing the lever and then resume Push down on the wiper control lever to activate a single
wipe to clear the windshield of road mist or spray from
the intermittent interval previously selected.
a passing vehicle. As long as the lever is held down, the
If you activate the washer while the wiper control is in
wipers will continue to operate.
the off position, the wipers will operate for two wipe
cycles and then turn off.
3
174 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The mist feature does not activate the washer
pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on the
windshield. The wash function must be used in order to
spray the windshield with washer fluid.
Headlights With Wipers Feature (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only)
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on
approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on
if the multifunction lever (on the left side of the steering
column) is placed in the AUTO position. In addition, the
headlights will turn off when the wipers are turned off if
they were turned on by this feature.
The headlights with wipers feature can be turned on or
off through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center
(EVIC) — if equipped. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings (CustomerProgrammable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Mist Control
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 175
TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen or
shorten the steering column. The tilt/telescoping lever is
located below the steering wheel at the end of the
steering column.
To unlock the steering column, push the lever downward. To tilt the steering column, move the steering
wheel upward or downward as desired. To lengthen or
shorten the steering column, pull the steering wheel
outward or push it inward as desired. To lock the steering
column in position, pull the lever upward until fully
engaged.
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
Tilt/Telescoping Lever
3
176 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph
(40 km/h).
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the
right side of the steering wheel.
Electronic Speed Control Buttons
1 — ON/OFF
4 — CANCEL
2 — RES +
3 — SET -
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 177
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control System has been designed to shut
down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control
System can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic
Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have an accident. Always
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
To Activate
To Set A Desired Speed
Push the ON/OFF button. The Cruise Indicator Light in
the instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system
off, push the ON/OFF button a second time. The Cruise
Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be
turned off when not in use.
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
has reached the desired speed, press the SET (-) button
and release. Release the accelerator and the vehicle will
operate at the selected speed.
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed
and on level ground before pressing the SET button.
3
178 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Pressing the RES (+) button once will result in a 1 mph
(1.6 km/h) increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANCEL
the button results in an increase of 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
button, or normal brake pressure while slowing the
vehicle will deactivate Electronic Speed Control without To decrease speed while the Electronic Speed Control is
erasing the set speed memory. Pressing the ON/OFF set, push the SET (-) button. If the button is continually
button or turning the ignition switch OFF erases the set held in the SET (-) position, the set speed will continue to
decrease until the button is released. Release the button
speed memory.
when the desired speed is reached, and the new set speed
To Resume Speed
will be established.
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+)
Pressing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 mph
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
(1.6 km/h) decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
above 20 mph (32 km/h).
the button results in a decrease of 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
To Vary The Speed Setting
To Accelerate For Passing
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can inPress the accelerator as you would normally. When the
crease speed by pushing the RES (+) button. If the button
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to
increase until the button is released, then the new set
speed will be established.
To Deactivate
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 179
Using Electronic Speed Control On Hills
GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED
The transmission may downshift on hills to maintain the HomeLink威 replaces up to three hand-held transmitters
vehicle set speed.
that operate devices such as garage door openers, motorized gates, lighting or home security systems. The
NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains
HomeLink威 unit is powered by your vehicles 12 Volt
speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on
battery.
moderate hills is normal.
On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so
it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed
Control.
WARNING!
Electronic Speed Control can be dangerous where the
system cannot maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle
could go too fast for the conditions, and you could lose
control and have an accident. Do not use Electronic
Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads that are
winding, icy, snow-covered or slippery.
3
180 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The HomeLink威 buttons, located on either the overhead
console, headliner or sunvisor, designate the three different HomeLink威 channels.The HomeLink威 indicator is
located above the center button.
HomeLink威 Buttons/Sunvisor/Headliner
NOTE: HomeLink威 is disabled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
HomeLink威 Buttons/Overhead Consoles
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 181
Before You Begin Programming HomeLink姞
NOTE:
Be sure that your vehicle is parked outside of the garage • Erasing all channels should only be performed when
before you begin programming.
programming HomeLink威 for the first time. Do not
erase
channels when programming additional buttons.
For more efficient programming and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal it is recommended that • If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of
call toll-free 1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet at
the device that is being programmed to the HomeLink威
www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
system.
Erase all channels before you begin programming. To
erase the channels place the ignition in the ON/RUN
position and press and hold the two outside HomeLink威
buttons (I and III) for up 20 seconds or until the red
indicator flashes.
3
182 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Programming A Rolling Code
For programming garage door openers that were manufactured after 1995. These garage door openers can be
identified by the “LEARN” or “TRAIN” button located
where the hanging antenna is attached to the garage door
opener. It is NOT the button that is normally used to
open and close the door. The name and color of the
button may vary by manufacturer.
Training The Garage Door Opener
1 — Door Opener
2 — Training Button
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 183
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm)
away from the HomeLink威 button you wish to program while keeping the HomeLink威 indicator light in
view.
3. Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink威
button you want to program and the hand-held transmitter button.
5. At the garage door opener motor (in the garage),
locate the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. This can
usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is
attached to the garage door opener/device motor.
Firmly press and release the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. On some garage door openers/devices
there may be a light that blinks when the garage door
opener/device is in the LEARN/TRAIN mode.
NOTE: You have 30 seconds in which to initiate the next
4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indi- step after the LEARN button has been pressed.
cator light. The Homelink威 indicator will flash slowly
6. Return to the vehicle and press the programmed
and then rapidly after Homelink威 has received the
HomeLink威 button twice (holding the button for two
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Reseconds each time). If the garage door opener/device
lease both buttons after the indicator light changes
activates, programming is complete.
from slow to rapid.
NOTE: If the garage door opener/device does not activate, press the button a third time (for two seconds) to
complete the training.
3
184 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To program the remaining two HomeLink威 buttons, Programming A Non-Rolling Code
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT For programming Garage Door Openers manufactured
erase the channels.
before 1995.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink威 Button
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained,
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm) away
follow these steps:
from the HomeLink威 button you wish to program while
keeping the HomeLink威 indicator light in view.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink威 button until 3. Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink威
button you want to program and the hand-held transthe indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do
mitter button.
not release the button.
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Program- 4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indicator light. The Homelink威 indicator will flash slowly
ming A Rolling Code” Step 2 and follow all remaining
and then rapidly after HomeLink威 has received the
steps.
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons after the indicator light changes
from slow to rapid.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 185
5. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink威 button
and observe the indicator light.
• If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and the garage door/device should
activate when the HomeLink威 button is pressed.
• To program the two remaining HomeLink威 buttons,
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
erase the channels.
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Programming A Non-Rolling Code” Step 2 and follow all
remaining steps.
Canadian/Gate Operator Programming
For programming transmitters in Canada/United States
that require the transmitter signals to “time-out” after
several seconds of transmission.
Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds of transTo reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, mission – which may not be long enough for HomeLink威
follow these steps:
to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this
Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
time-out in the same manner.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink威 button until
It may be helpful to unplug the device during the cycling
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do
process to prevent possible overheating of the garage
not release the button.
door or gate motor.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink威 Button
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
3
186 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm) away
from the HomeLink威 button you wish to program while
keeping the HomeLink威 indicator light in view.
• To program the two remaining HomeLink威 buttons,
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
erase the channels.
3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink威 button,
while you press and release (“cycle”), your hand-held
transmitter every two seconds until HomeLink威 has
successfully accepted the frequency signal. The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly when
fully trained.
If you unplugged the garage door opener/device for
programming, plug it back in at this time.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink威 Button
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained,
follow these steps:
4. Watch for the HomeLink威 indicator to change flash 1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
rates. When it changes, it is programmed. It may take
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink威 button until
up to 30 seconds or longer in rare cases. The garage
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do
door may open and close while you are programming.
not release the button.
5. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink威 button
3. Without releasing the button proceed with
and observe the indicator light.
“Canadian/Gate Operator Programming” Step 2 and
• If the indicator light stays on constantly, programfollow all remaining steps.
ming is complete and the garage door/device should
activate when the HomeLink威 button is pressed.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 187
Using HomeLink姞
Troubleshooting Tips
To operate, press and release the programmed
HomeLink威 button. Activation will now occur for the
programmed device (i.e., garage door opener, gate operator, security system, entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.,). The hand-held transmitter of the device may
also be used at any time.
If you are having trouble programming HomeLink威, here
are some of the most common solutions:
Security
It is advised to erase all channels before you sell or turn
in your vehicle.
• Replace the battery in the original hand-held transmitter.
• Press the LEARN button on the Garage Door Opener
to complete the training for a Rolling Code.
• Did you unplug the device for programming and
remember to plug it back in?
If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
To do this, press and hold the two outside buttons for 20 call toll-free 1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet at
seconds until the red indicator flashes. Note that all www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
channels will be erased. Individual channels cannot be
erased.
The HomeLink威 Universal Transceiver is disabled when
the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
3
188 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Your motorized door or gate will open and close
while you are programming the universal transceiver. Do not program the transceiver if people,
pets or other objects are in the path of the door or
gate. Only use this transceiver with a garage door
opener that has a “stop and reverse” feature as
required by Federal safety standards. This includes
most garage door opener models manufactured
after 1982. Do not use a garage door opener without
these safety features. Call toll-free 1–800–355–3515
or, on the Internet at www.HomeLink.com for
safety information or assistance.
• Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not run your vehicle in the garage
while programming the transceiver. Exhaust gas
can cause serious injury or death.
General Information
This device complies with FCC rules Part 15 and Industry
Canada RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference that may be
received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
• The transmitter has been tested and it complies with FCC
and IC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate the device.
• The term IC before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 189
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED
The sunroof controls are mounted between the dome/
reading lights.
Power Sunroof Switch
WARNING!
• Never leave children in a vehicle with the key in
the ignition switch (or with the ignition in the
Accessory or Run position, for vehicles equipped
with Keyless Enter-N-Go™). Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped
by the power sunroof while operating the power
sunroof switch. Such entrapment may result in
serious injury or death.
• In a collision, there is a greater risk of being thrown
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could
also be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are also properly secured.
• Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.
Never allow your fingers, other body parts, or any
object, to project through the sunroof opening.
Injury may result.
3
190 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
position. The sunroof will close fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Close”. During Express
Press the switch rearward and release it within one-half
Close operation, any movement of the switch will stop
second and the sunroof will open automatically from any
the sunroof.
position. The sunroof will open fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Open”. During Express Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode
Open operation, any movement of the sunroof switch
To close the sunroof, press and hold the switch in the
will stop the sunroof.
forward position. Any release of the switch will stop the
Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode
movement and the sunroof will remain in a partially
To open the sunroof, press and hold the switch rearward closed condition until the switch is pushed and held
to full open. Any release of the switch will stop the forward again.
Opening Sunroof — Express
movement and the sunroof will remain in a partially Pinch Protect Feature
opened condition until the switch is pushed and held
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of
rearward again.
the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obClosing Sunroof — Express
struction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the
Press the switch forward and release it within one-half sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstrucsecond and the sunroof will close automatically from any tion if this occurs. Next, press the switch forward and
release to Express Close.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 191
NOTE: If three consecutive sunroof close attempts result in Pinch Protect reversals, the fourth close attempt
will be a Manual Close movement with Pinch Protect
disabled.
Venting Sunroof — Express
Press and release the Vent button within one half second
and the sunroof will open to the vent position. This is
called “Express Vent”, and it will occur regardless of
sunroof position. During Express Vent operation, any
movement of the switch will stop the sunroof.
Sunshade Operation
The sunshade can be opened manually. However, the
sunshade will open automatically as the sunroof opens.
NOTE: The sunshade cannot be closed if the sunroof is
open.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
minimize the buffeting or open any window.
3
192 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Sunroof Maintenance
ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS
Use only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to clean There are two 12 Volt (13 Amp) electrical power outlets on
this vehicle. Both of the power outlets are protected by a
the glass panel.
fuse.
Ignition Off Operation
The instrument panel power outlet, located below the
For Vehicles Not Equipped With The Electronic Vehicle
climate control knobs, has power available only when the
Information Center (EVIC)
ignition is ON. This power outlet will also operate a
The power sunroof switch will remain active for 45 conventional cigar lighter unit.
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
position. Opening either front door will cancel this
feature.
For Vehicles Equipped With The EVIC
The power sunroof switch will remain active for up to
approximately ten minutes after the ignition switch is
turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door
will cancel this feature.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 193
3
Instrument Panel Power Outlet
Center Console Power Outlet
NOTE: To preserve the heating element, do not hold the The center console power outlet is powered directly from
lighter in the heating position.
the battery (power available at all times). Items plugged
into this power outlet may discharge the battery and/or
A second power outlet is located inside the center conprevent the engine from starting.
sole.
194 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: To ensure proper operation a MOPAR威 knob and
element must be used.
CAUTION!
• Do not exceed the maximum power of 160 Watts (13
Amps) at 12 Volts. If the 160 Watt (13 Amp) power
rating is exceeded the fuse protecting the system
will need to be replaced.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs only.
Do not insert any other object in the power outlets as
this will damage the outlet and blow the fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can cause damage not
covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Power Outlet Fuse Locations
1 — #16 Fuse 15 A Blue Cigar Lighter Instrument Panel
2 — #11 Fuse 15 A Blue Power Outlet Inside Arm Rest
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 195
WARNING!
CAUTION!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with greater caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories, or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
generator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
3
196 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
EQUIPPED
An optional ash receiver is available from your authorized dealer and will fit in the center console front
cupholder.
The optional ash receiver also comes with a cigar lighter
that can be used with the power outlets. Refer to “Power
Outlets” in “Understanding the Features of Your Vehicle”
for further information.
CUPHOLDERS
Front Cupholders
Front Seat Cupholders
Rear Cupholders
The cupholders in the center console will accommodate
either two large size cups or two 20 oz (.5 L) bottles or The rear seat cupholders are located in the armrest
cans. The one-peice insert can be easily removed for between the rear seats. Pull down the armrest to use the
cleaning. An optional removable ashtray may be located cupholders.
in one of the cupholders.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 197
3
Rear Cupholders
Rear Seat Bottle Holder
There are built-in bottle holders located in both rear door
trim panels.
Rear Bottle Holder
WARNING!
If containers of hot liquid are placed in the bottle
holder, they can spill when the door is closed, burning the occupants. Be careful when closing the doors
to avoid injury.
198 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
STORAGE
Glovebox Storage Compartment
The glovebox storage compartment is located on the right
side of the instrument panel. To open the glovebox, pull
outward on the latch handle located on the front of the
glovebox.
Glovebox Storage Compartment
CONSOLE FEATURES
Storage
The center console is located between the front driver
and passenger seats. The center console armrest slides
forward from design position to provide added user
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 199
comfort. The center console can be used for storage and
is also equipped with an electrical power outlet. Refer to
“Power Outlets” in “Understanding The Feature of Your
Vehicle” for further information.
3
Center Console Storage
The top compartment holds small items, such as a pen
and note pad, while the larger bottom compartment will
hold CDs and alike. The bottom compartment also contains a 12 Volt power outlet. The console’s front opening
Center Console Armrest
Two separate storage compartments are also located lid allows for easy access to these compartments.
underneath the armrest.
200 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
CARGO AREA FEATURES
• A notch in the front of the console base allows for use The 60/40 split-folding rear seat provides cargo-carrying
of a cellular phone while it is plugged into the power versatility. The seatbacks fold down easily by pulling
nylon tabs between the seatbacks and the bolsters. When
outlet with the armrest latched down.
the seats are folded down, they provide a continuous,
• The power outlet can also energize the cigar lighter in nearly flat extension of the load floor.
the optional cup holder ash receiver.
When the seatback is folded to the upright position, make
sure it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the
WARNING!
seatback above the seat strap.
Do not operate this vehicle with a console compartment lid in the open position. Cellular phones, music
WARNING!
players, and other handheld electronic devices
• Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into
should be stowed while driving. Use of these devices
position. If the seatback in not securely locked into
while driving can cause an accident due to distracposition, the seat will not provide the proper station, resulting in death or injury.
bility for child seats and/or passengers. An improperly latched seat could cause serious injury.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 201
WARNING! (Continued)
• The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle (with the
rear seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down
position) should not be used as a play area by
children when the vehicle is in motion. They could
be seriously injured in a collision. Children should
be seated and using the proper restraint system.
• To help protect against personal injury, passengers
should not be seated in the rear cargo area. The rear
cargo space is intended for load carrying purposes
only, not for passengers, who should sit in seats
and use seat belts.
• The weight and position of cargo and passengers
can change the vehicle center of gravity and vehicle
handling. To avoid loss of control resulting in
personal injury, follow these guidelines for loading
your vehicle:
Always place cargo evenly on the cargo floor. Put heavier
objects as low and as far forward as possible. Place as
much cargo as possible in front of the rear axle. Too much
weight or improperly placed weight over or behind the
rear axle can cause the rear of the vehicle to sway.
Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the top of the
seatback. This could impair visibility or become a dangerous projectile in a sudden stop or collision.
3
202 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Ski Pass-Through
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
There is a ski pass-through door located behind the rear Rear Window Defroster
seat armrest that allows longer items, such as snow skis,
to be stored in the rear cargo area. Lower the armrest and
The rear window defroster button is located on
pull downward on the latch to open the ski pass-through
the climate control (Mode) knob. Press this button
door.
to turn on the rear window defroster and the heated
outside mirrors (if equipped). An indicator in the button
will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The
rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 10 minutes. For an additional five minutes of
operation, press the button a second time.
NOTE: To prevent excessive battery drain, use the rear
window defroster only when the engine is operating.
Ski Pass-Through
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 203
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
3
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES. . . . . . . . . . .208
▫ EVIC Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
▫ Compass Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . . .210
▫ Average Fuel Economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
䡵 MINI-TRIP COMPUTER — IF EQUIPPED . . . . .223
▫ Distance To Empty (DTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
▫ Control Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
▫ Tire PSI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
䡵 ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC) — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
▫ Elapsed Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
▫ Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
▫ Oil Change Required — If Equipped . . . . . . .228
▫ EVIC Units Selection (UNITS IN Display) . . . .234
▫ System Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
▫ Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Features) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
4
206 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
䡵 SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . .238
▫ Operating Instructions — Radio Mode. . . . . . .249
䡵 Uconnect威 730N/430/430N CD/DVD/HDD/NAV
— IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
▫ Operation Instructions — CD MODE for CD and
MP3 Audio Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
▫ Operating Instructions (Voice Command System)
— If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
▫ Notes On Playing MP3 Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
▫ Operating Instructions (Uconnect威 Phone) — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
䡵 UCONNECT威 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
▫ Operating Instructions — Radio Mode. . . . . . .249
▫ Operation Instructions — CD MODE For CD And
MP3 Audio Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
▫ Notes on Playing MP3 Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode . . . . .247
䡵 UCONNECT威 130 WITH SATELLITE RADIO . . .248
▫ LIST Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play) . . . . . . .260
▫ INFO Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play) . . . . . .260
▫ Uconnect威 (Satellite Radio) — If Equipped. . . .261
䡵 iPod威/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED . .265
▫ Connecting The iPod威 Or External USB
Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
▫ Using This Feature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
▫ Controlling The iPod威 Or External USB Device
Using Radio Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
▫ Play Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 207
▫ List Or Browse Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269 䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND
PHONES . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Bluetooth Streaming Audio (BTSA) . . . . . . . . .271
䡵 CLIMATE CONTROLS . . .
䡵 STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
▫ Manual Heating And Air
▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
▫ CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
䡵 CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . .274
MOBILE
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Conditioning . . . . . .275
▫ Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
4
208 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
1
2
3
4
5
— Air Outlet
— Side Window Demister Outlet
— Instrument Cluster
— Ignition Switch
— Analog Clock
6 — Radio
7 — Passenger Airbag
8 — Glove Compartment
9 — Heated Seat Switch – If Equipped
10 — Hazard Switch
11 — Storage Compartment
12 — Climate Control
13 — Trunk Release Button
14 — Power Outlet
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 209
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
4
210 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
removes this heat. You can also turn the Temperature
control to maximum heat, the Mode control to Floor and
1. Temperature Gauge
the Fan control to High. This allows the heater core to act
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant tempera- as a supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat
ture. Any reading below the red mark of the gauge shows from the engine cooling system.
that the engine cooling system is operating properly. The
2. Fuel Door Reminder
gauge pointer may show a higher than normal temperature when driving in hot weather, up mountain grades, in
This is a reminder that the Fuel Filler Door is
heavy stop and go traffic, or when towing a trailer.
located on the left side of the vehicle.
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
If the pointer rises to the H (red) mark, the instrument
cluster will sound a chime. Pull over and stop the vehicle.
Idle the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until
the pointer drops back into the normal range. If the
pointer remains on the H (red) mark, turn the engine off
immediately and call for service.
3. Fuel Gauge
When the ignition switch is in the ON/RUN position, the
pointer will show the level of fuel remaining in the fuel
tank.
There are steps that you can take to slow down an 4. Speedometer
impending overheat condition. If your air conditioning is Indicates the vehicle speed in miles per hour (MPH) and
on, turn it off. The air conditioning system adds heat to kilometers per hour (km/h).
the engine cooling system and turning off the A/C
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 211
5. Low Fuel Light
If jump starting is required, refer to “Jump Starting
Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies”.
When the fuel level drops to approximately 2.0
gallons (7.6 Liters), the fuel symbol will light and 7. Air Bag Warning Light
a single chime will sound.
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds
as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first
NOTE: This light will remain on until a minimum of
turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on
approximately 3.0 gallons of fuel is added.
during starting, stays on, or turns on while
6. Charging System Light
driving, have the system inspected at an authorized
This light shows the status of the electrical charg- dealer as soon as possible. Refer to “Occupant Restraints”
ing system. The light should come on briefly in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
when the ignition is first turned on and remain on briefly further information.
as a bulb check. If the light stays on or comes on while 8. Seat Belt Reminder Light
driving, turn off some of the vehicle’s electrical devices,
When the ignition switch is first turned to ON/
such as the Front Fog Lights or Rear Window Defroster.
RUN, this light will turn on for four to eight
If the Charging System Light remains on, it means that
seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb check, if
the vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging
system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See your local the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a chime will sound.
After the bulb check or when driving, if the driver seat
authorized dealer.
belt remains unbuckled, the Seat Belt Warning Light will
4
212 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
flash or remain on continuously. Refer to “Occupant 10. Engine Temperature Warning Light
Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your
This light warns of an overheated engine condiVehicle” for further information.
tion. As engine coolant temperatures rise and the
9. Oil Pressure Warning Light
gauge approaches H, this indicator will illuminate and a
single chime will sound after reaching a set threshold.
This light indicates low engine oil pressure. The
Further overheating will cause the temperature gauge to
light will come on and remain on when the ignition
pass H, and a continuous chime will occur until the
switch is turned from the OFF to the ON/RUN position,
engine is allowed to cool or the 4 minutes duration is
and the light will turn off after the engine is started. If the
expired, whichever come first.
bulb does not come on during starting, have the system
If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over and
checked by an authorized dealer.
stop the vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it off. Also,
If the light comes on and remains on while driving, stop
shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and idle the vethe vehicle and shut off the engine. DO NOT OPERATE
hicle. If the temperature reading does not return to
THE VEHICLE UNTIL THE CAUSE IS CORRECTED.
normal, turn the engine off immediately and call for
The light does not show the quantity of oil in the engine. service. Refer to “If Your Engine Overheats” in “What To
This can be determined using the procedure shown in Do In Emergencies” for further information.
“Maintaining Your Vehicle”.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 213
11. Brake Warning Light
This light monitors various brake functions,
including brake fluid level and parking brake
application. If the brake light turns on it may
indicate that the parking brake is applied, that
the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with
the anti-lock brake system.
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. Failure of either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has
dropped below a specified level.
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the brake light on is dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed. It will
take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have a
collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
Vehicles equipped with Anti-Lock brakes (ABS), are also
equipped with Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD).
In the event of an EBD failure, the Brake Warning Light
will turn on along with the ABS Light. Immediate repair
to the ABS system is required.
The operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp by turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to
cornering maneuvers which change fluid level condi- the ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for
tions. The vehicle should have service performed, and approximately three seconds. The light should then turn
the brake fluid level checked.
4
214 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
off unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is NOTE: You must apply the brakes before shifting from
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light PARK.
inspected by an authorized dealer.
14. Odometer Display/Trip Odometer Display
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
The odometer display shows the total distance the veapplied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN posihicle has been driven.
tion.
U.S. Federal regulations require that upon transfer of
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application. correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. If your
odometer needs to be repaired or serviced, the repair
12. Tachometer
technician should leave the odometer reading the same
The silver area of the scale shows the permissible engine as it was before the repair or service. If s/he cannot do so,
revolutions-per-minute (RPM x 1000) for each gear range. then the odometer must be set at zero, and a sticker must
Before reaching the red area, ease up on the accelerator to be placed in the door jamb stating what the mileage was
prevent engine damage.
before the repair or service. It is a good idea for you to
13. Shift Lever Indicator
make a record of the odometer reading before the repair/
service, so that you can be sure that it is properly reset, or
The Shift Lever Indicator is self-contained within the
that the door jamb sticker is accurate if the odometer
instrument cluster. It displays the gear position of the
must be reset at zero.
automatic transmission.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 215
The two trip odometers show individual trip mileage. To
switch from odometer to trip odometers, press and
release the Trip Odometer button. To reset a trip odometer, display the desired trip odometer to be reset then
push and hold the button until the display resets (approximately 2 seconds). Refer to “Trip Odometer Button”
for additional information.
gASCAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Cap Fault
HOTOIL . . . . . . . . . Engine Oil Temperature Exceeds
Safe Threshold
NOTE: If the instrument cluster is equipped with the
optional Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC), then
warnings such as ”Low Tire,” “Door Ajar” and “Trunk
Vehicle Odometer Messages
Ajar” will display in the EVIC. (Refer to “Electronic Vehicle
When the appropriate conditions exist, the odometer will Information Center (EVIC)” for specific messages).
display the following messages:
LoW tirE
door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Door Ajar When the appropriate condition exists, the odometer display will toggle between LoW and tirE for three cycles.
dECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trunk Ajar
HOTOIL
LoW tirE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low Tire Pressure When this message is displayed there is a engine oil
over-temperature condition. When this condition occurs,
CHANgE OIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Change Required the “HOTOIL” message will be displayed in the odometer along with a chime.
4
216 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
seconds after a single chime has sounded to indicate the
next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
gASCAP
engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
If the vehicle diagnostic system detects a leak or change your personal driving style.
in the evaporative system, or the fuel filler cap is loose,
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each
improperly installed, or damaged, the words “gASCAP”
time you turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position.
will display in the odometer display area. If this occurs,
To turn off the message temporarily, press and release the
tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the odomTrip Odometer button on the instrument cluster. To reset
eter reset button to turn off the “gASCAP” message.
the oil change indicator system (after performing the
(Refer to “Onboard Diagnostic System — OBDII” in
scheduled maintenance) perform the following proce“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information). If
dure:
the problem continues, the message will appear the next
time the vehicle is started. See your authorized dealer Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position (do not
service center as soon as possible.
start the engine).
Refer to “If Your Engine Overheats” in “What To Do In
Emergencies”.
CHANgE OIL
Fully depress the accelerator pedal slowly 3 times within
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change 10 seconds.
indicator system. The “CHANgE OIL” message will flash Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
in the instrument cluster odometer for approximately 12
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 217
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you To reset the trip odometer, first display the trip mileage
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not that you want to reset, “Trip A” or “Trip B.” Then push
reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
and hold the button (approximately 2 seconds) until the
display resets to 0 miles (km). The odometer must be in
For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle InforTrip Mode to reset the trip odometer.
mation Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle Infor17. Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Indicator Light
mation Center (EVIC)”.
This light informs you of a problem with the
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. If a
This indicator shows that the Electronic Speed
problem is detected, the light will come on
Control System is ON.
while the engine is running. If the light remains
16. Odometer/Trip Odometer Reset Button
lit with the engine running, your vehicle will usually be
drivable and not need towing, however see your authoTrip Odometer
rized dealer for service as soon as possible.
Press and release this button to change the display from
If the light is flashing when the engine is running you
odometer to “Trip A.” Press and release it a second time
may experience power loss, an elevated/rough idle, and
to change the display to “Trip B.” Press and release it a
increased brake pedal effort, and your vehicle may
third time to change the display back to the odometer.
require towing. Immediate service is required.
15. Cruise Indicator — If Equipped
4
218 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The light will come on when the ignition switch is first 20. Turn Signal Indicators
turned on and remain briefly as a bulb check. This is
The arrows will flash in unison with the exterior
normal. If the light does not come on during starting,
turn signal, when using the turn signal lever. A
have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
chime will sound if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile
18. Park/Headlight ON Indicator — If Equipped
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on.
This indicator will illuminate when the park NOTE: If either indicator flashes at a rapid rate, check
lights or headlights are turned on.
for a defective outside light bulb.
21. Front Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped
19. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator
Light — If Equipped
This indicator will illuminate when the front fog
lights are on.
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Con- 22. Vehicle Security Light — If Equipped
trol system (ESC) has been turned off by the
This light will flash rapidly for approximately
driver.
16 seconds when the alarm system is arming.
The light will begin to flash slowly indicating
that the system is armed. The light will stop
flashing when the vehicle is disarmed.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 219
23. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light — If Equipped
should come on. If the light does not come on, have the
system inspected by an authorized dealer.
This light monitors the ABS. This light will
come on when the ignition key is turned to the 24. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Activation/
ON/RUN position and may stay on for ap- Malfunction Indicator Light — If Equipped
proximately three seconds.
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
If the ABS light remains on or comes on during driving,
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
it indicates that the Anti-Lock portion of the brake system
when the ignition switch is turned to the
is not functioning and that service is required, however,
ON/RUN position. It should go out with the
the conventional brake system will continue to operate engine running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Innormally provided that the BRAKE warning light is not dicator Light” comes on continuously with the engine
on.
running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced system. If this light remains on after several ignition
as soon as possible to restore the benefit of Anti-Lock cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles
(kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see
Brakes.
your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the
The ABS warning light should be checked frequently to problem diagnosed and corrected.
assure that it is operating properly. Turn the ignition key
to the on position, but do not start the vehicle. The light
4
220 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those
The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC Activation/
tires.)
Malfunction Indicator Light” come on momentarily each
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been
time the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN.
equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the ESC (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when
system will be ON, even if it was turned off previously. one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illumiwhen it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop nates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as
when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver that possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
caused the ESC activation.
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
25. Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
should be checked monthly when cold and Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the low tire pressure telltale.
NOTE:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 221
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
CAUTION!
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is The TPMS has been optimized for the original
combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for warning have been established for the tire size
approximately one minute and then remain continuously equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operailluminated. This sequence will continue upon subse- tion or sensor damage may result when using requent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. placement equipment that is not of the same size,
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the sys- type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
tem may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure sensor damage. Do not use tire sealant from a can or
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with a
of reasons, including the installation of replacement or TPMS, as damage to the sensors may result.
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the 26. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more
The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part of
tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the
an onboard diagnostic system called OBD that
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
monitors emissions, engine, and automatic transto continue to function properly.
mission control systems. The light will illuminate when
the key is in the ON/RUN position before engine start. If
4
222 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
the bulb does not come on when turning the key from
LOCK to ON/RUN, have the condition checked
promptly.
WARNING!
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as referenced
Certain conditions, such as a loose or missing gas cap, above, can reach higher temperatures than in normal
poor fuel quality, etc., may illuminate the light after operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you drive
engine start. The vehicle should be serviced if the light slowly or park over flammable substances such as dry
stays on through several of your typical driving cycles. In plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result in death
most situations, the vehicle will drive normally and will or serious injury to the driver, occupants or others.
not require towing.
27. Transmission Temperature Warning Light — If
Equipped
CAUTION!
Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
damage to the engine control system. It also could
affect fuel economy and drivability. If the MIL is
flashing, severe catalytic converter damage and
power loss will soon occur. Immediate service is
required.
This light indicates that the transmission fluid
temperature is running hot. This may occur
with severe usage, such as trailer towing. If this
light turns on while driving, safely pull over
and stop the vehicle. Then, shift the transmission into
NEUTRAL and run the engine at idle or faster until the
light turns off.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 223
CAUTION!
29. Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display — If Equipped
Continuous driving with the Transmission Temperature Warning Light illuminated will eventually cause
severe transmission damage or transmission failure.
This display shows the EVIC messages when the appropriate conditions exist. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” for further information.
WARNING!
If the Transmission Temperature Warning Light is
illuminated and you continue operating the vehicle,
in some circumstances you could cause the fluid to
boil over, come in contact with hot engine or exhaust
components and cause a fire.
MINI-TRIP COMPUTER — IF EQUIPPED
The Mini-Trip Computer is located in the instrument
cluster and features a driver-interactive trip information
and temperature display.
NOTE: The system will display the last known outside
temperature when starting the vehicle and may need to
be driven several minutes before the updated tempera28. High Beam Indicator
ture is displayed. Engine temperature can also affect the
This light indicates that the headlights are on high displayed temperature; therefore, temperature readings
beam. Pull the turn signal lever toward the steer- are not updated when the vehicle is not moving.
ing wheel to switch the headlights to low beam.
4
224 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Control Buttons
RESET Button
To reset the display shown, turn the ignition switch to the
ON position, then press and hold the RESET button
located on the steering wheel.
The following displays can be reset or changed:
• Trip A
• Trip B
Trip Odometer (ODO)
This display shows the distance traveled since the last
reset. Press and release the STEP button on the instrument cluster to switch from odometer, to Trip A or Trip B.
Mini-Trip Control Buttons
STEP Button
Trip A
Shows the total distance traveled for Trip A since the last
Press the STEP button located on the steering wheel to reset.
scroll through sub menus (i.e., Temperature, Trip Functions: Odometer, Trip A, Trip B).
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 225
Trip B
Shows the total distance traveled for Trip B since the last
reset.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC) — IF EQUIPPED
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the
instrument cluster.
4
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
226 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The EVIC consists of the following:
The system allows the driver to select information by
pressing the following buttons on the instrument panel
• Compass Heading Display (N, S, E, W, NE, NW, SE, SW)
switch bank located below the climate controls:
• Mileage (Avg/MPG)
• Miles To Empty
• Low Tire Information (Tire Pressure Monitor System
(TPMS) Displays) — if equipped
• Timer
• Units
• System Warnings (Door Ajar, etc.)
• Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)
• Outside Temperature Display (°F or °C)
• Audio Mode Displays – 12 preset Radio Stations or CD
Title and Track number when playing
EVIC Steering Wheel Buttons
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 227
MENU Button
SELECT Button
Press and release the MENU button to advance
Press and release the SELECT Button to accept
the display to each of the EVIC Main Menu
a selection. The SELECT Button also resets
features. Upon reaching the last item in the Main
various Trip Functions.
Menu the EVIC will advance to the first item in
the Main Menu with the next MENU button press and Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Displays
release.
DOWN Button
When the appropriate conditions exist, the EVIC displays
the following messages:
Press and release the DOWN button to advance
the display through the various Trip Functions • Turn Signal On (with a continuous warning chime
after one mile traveled)
or Personal Settings.
COMPASS Button
• Left Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
Press and release the COMPASS button to • Left Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
display the compass heading, the outside tem- • Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single
perature, and Audio Info (when the radio is on)
chime)
screen when the current screen is not the
• Right Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
compass, outside temp, audio info screen.
4
228 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• RKE (Remote Keyless Entry) Battery Low (with a •
single chime)
•
• Personal Settings Not Avail – Vehicle Not In PARK
•
• Personal Settings Not Avail – Vehicle in Motion
•
• Door Ajar (with vehicle graphic showing which door is
•
open. A single chime sounds if the vehicle is in
motion).
•
• Doors Ajar (with vehicle graphic showing which doors
are open. A single chime sounds if the vehicle is in
motion).
• Trunk Open (with vehicle graphic showing and open
trunk and A single chime )
• Lights On
• Key In Ignition
• Remote start aborted — Door ajar
Remote start aborted — Hood ajar
Remote start aborted — Trunk ajar
Remote start aborted — Fuel low
Remote start disabled — System fault
Oil Change Required (with a single chime)
Low Tire (with a graphic of the car showing which
tire(s) is/are low - with a single chime). Refer to ⬙Tire
Pressure Monitoring System⬙ in ⬙Starting and
Operating⬙.
• Check TPM System (with a single chime) Refer to ⬙Tire
Pressure Monitoring System⬙ in ⬙Starting and Operating⬙.
Oil Change Required — If Equipped
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change
indicator system. The Oil Change Required message will
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 229
flash in the EVIC display for approximately five seconds
after a single chime has sounded to indicate the next
scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
your personal driving style.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
reset. If necessary repeat this procedure.
EVIC Main Menu
To step to each main menu feature press and release the
MENU button once for each step. A step from the last
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each
item in the list will cause the first item in the feature list
time you turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN
to be displayed. The following features are in the Main
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and
menu:
release the MENU button. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled maintenance), • Compass
perform the following procedure:
• Outside Temperature
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not
• Audio Information (if radio is on) display
start the engine.)
• Average Fuel Economy
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal slowly three times
• Distance to Empty
within 10 seconds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
• Tire Pressure Status display
4
230 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Elapsed Time
Compass Display
• EVIC Units Selection
COMPASS Button
• System Status
The compass heading indicates the direction
the vehicle is facing. Press and release the
• Personal Settings
compass button to display one of eight compass headings, the outside temperature, and
NOTE: For features in the EVIC that can be reset (Average Fuel Economy and Elapsed Time), the EVIC prompts audio information (if the radio is on) if the EVIC display
a reset with a SELECT button graphic and the word is not already displaying this screen.
RESET next to it.
NOTE: The system will display the last known outside
When the SELECT button is pressed, the selected feature
will reset and RESET ALL will display next to the
SELECT button graphic. Pressing SELECT a second time
will reset both Average Fuel Economy and Elapsed Time.
After three seconds without pressing SELECT, RESET
ALL will return to RESET and only the selected feature
will have been reset.
temperature when starting the vehicle and may need to
be driven several minutes before the updated temperature is displayed. Engine temperature can also affect the
displayed temperature; therefore, temperature readings
are not updated when the vehicle is not moving.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 231
Automatic Compass Calibration
1. Start the engine. Leave the shift lever in PARK in order
to enter the EVIC Programming Menus.
This compass is self-calibrating, which eliminates the
need to calibrate the compass manually. When the ve- 2. Press and release the MENU button until “Personal
hicle is new, the compass may appear erratic and the
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
EVIC will flash the “CAL” indicator until the compass is
3. Press and release the DOWN button until “Calibrate
calibrated. You may calibrate the compass by completing
Compass Yes” displays in the EVIC.
one or more 360–degree turns (in an area free from large
metal or metallic objects) until the CAL indicator in the 4. Press and release the SELECT button and the “CAL”
EVIC turns off. The compass will now function normally.
indicator will start flashing.
NOTE: A good calibration requires a level surface and 5. Drive the vehicle slowly (under 5 mph / 8 km/h),
an environment free from large metallic objects such as
completing one or more circles (in an area free from large
buildings, bridges, underground cables, railroad tracks,
metal or metallic objects) until the “CAL” indicator turns
etc.
off. The compass will now function normally.
Manual Compass Calibration
If the compass appears erratic or inaccurate, and the
variance has been properly set, you may wish to manually recalibrate the compass. To manually calibrate the
compass:
4
232 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Compass Variance
Compass Variance is the difference between Magnetic
North and Geographic North. To compensate for the
differences, the variance should be set for the zone where
the vehicle is driven, per the zone map. Once properly
set, the compass will automatically compensate for the
differences and provide the most accurate compass heading.
NOTE: Magnetic and battery powered devices, (such as
cell phones, iPod’s, radar detectors, PDA’s and laptops)
should be kept away from the top of the instrument
Compass Variance Map
panel. This is where the compass module is located and
such devices may interfere and cause false compass To Change Compass Variance:
readings.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Leave the
shift lever in PARK.
2. Press and release the MENU button until “Personal
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 233
3. Press and release the DOWN button until “Compass Distance To Empty (DTE)
Variance” and the current Variance Value displays in Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with
the EVIC.
the fuel remaining in the tank. This estimated distance is
4. Press and release the SELECT button to increment the determined by a weighted average of the instantaneous
Variance Value by one, (one button press per update), and average fuel economy, according to the current fuel
until the proper variance zone is selected according to tank level. DTE cannot be reset.
the map.
NOTE: Significant changes in driving style or vehicle
NOTE: The Variance Values will wrap around from 15 loading will greatly affect the actual drivable distance of
the vehicle, regardless of the DTE display value.
back to 1. The Default Variance is Zone 8.
Average Fuel Economy
Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset.
Average Fuel Economy can be reset by pressing and
holding the SELECT button (as prompted in the EVIC
display). Upon reset, the history information will be
erased, and the averaging will continue from the last fuel
average reading before the reset.
When the DTE value is less than 30 miles (48 km)
estimated driving distance, the DTE display will change
to a text display of ⬙LOW FUEL”. This display will
continue until the vehicle runs out of fuel. Adding a
significant amount of fuel to the vehicle will turn off the
LOW FUEL text and a new DTE value will display.
4
234 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Tire PSI
Elapsed Time
Press and release the MENU button until ⬙Tire PSI⬙ is Shows the total elapsed time of travel since the last reset.
displayed.
Elapsed time will increment when the ignition switch is
in the RUN or START position.
Tire pressure information is displayed as follows:
Elapsed time is displayed as follows:
• If tire pressure is OK for all tires, TIRE and a vehicle
graphic are displayed with tire pressure values in each hours:minutes:seconds
corner or the graphic.
Elapsed time can be reset by pressing and holding the
• If one or more tires have low pressure, LOW TIRE and SELECT button (as prompted in the EVIC display). Upon
a vehicle graphic are displayed with tire pressure reset all digits will change to zeros and time will start
values in each corner of the graphic. Tire pressure incrementing again if the ignition switch is in RUN or
START.
values that are too low will be flashing.
• If the Tire Pressure System requires service, ⬙Check EVIC Units Selection (UNITS IN Display)
TPM System⬙ is displayed. Tire PSI is an information Displays the units used for the Outside Temperature,
only function and cannot be reset.
Average Fuel Economy, Distance to Empty and Tire
Pressure features. Press and Release the SELECT button
to toggle units between ⬙U.S.⬙ and ⬙METRIC⬙.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 235
System Status
Displays SYSTEM OK if there are no active Warning
Messages stored. Pressing and releasing the DOWN
button when SYSTEM OK is displayed will do nothing.
Displays SYSTEM WARNINGS PRESENT if there are
active Warning Messages stored. Pressing and releasing
the DOWN button when SYSTEM WARNINGS PRESENT is displayed will display each stored warning for
each button press. Press and Release the MENU button to
return to the Main Menu.
Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Features)
Press and release the DOWN button to display the
following programmable features:
Language
When in this display you may select different languages
for all display nomenclature, including the trip functions.
Pressing the SELECT button while in this display selects
English, Spanish, French, German, Italian, or Dutch depending on availability. As you continue, the displayed
information will be shown in the selected language.
Auto Unlock on Exit
When ON is selected and the transaxle is in the PARK or
NEUTRAL position, all doors will unlock when the
Personal Settings allows the driver to set and recall
driver’s door is opened. To make your selection, press the
features when the automatic transaxle is in PARK.
SELECT button until ON or OFF appears.
Press and release the MENU button until “Personal
RKE Unlock
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
When “Driver Door 1st Press” is selected, only the
driver’s door will unlock on the first press of the Remote
4
236 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter UNLOCK button. When
Driver Door 1st Press is selected, you must press the RKE
transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenger’s doors. When “All Doors 1st Press” is selected, all of
the doors will unlock on the first press of the RKE
transmitter UNLOCK button. To make your selection,
press and release the SELECT button until “Driver Door
1st Press” or “All Doors 1st Press” appears.
Sound Horn with Lock
When ON is selected, a short horn sound will occur when
the RKE transmitter LOCK button is pressed. This feature
may be selected with or without the Flash Lamp with
Lock feature. To make your selection, press and release
the SELECT button until ON or OFF appears.
without the Sound Horn on lock feature selected. To
make your selection, press and release the SELECT
button until ON or OFF appears.
Headlamp Off Delay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to
have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds
when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection, press
the SELECT button until 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds appears.
Headlamps With Wipers (Available with Auto
Headlights Only)
When ON is selected, and the headlight switch is in the
AUTO position, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on. The
headlights will also turn off when the wipers are turned
Flash Lamp with Lock
off if they were turned on by this feature. To make your
When ON is selected, the front and rear turn signals will selection, press the SELECT button until ON or OFF
flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the appears.
RKE transmitter. This feature may be selected with or
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 237
NOTE: Turning the headlights on during the daytime
causes the instrument panel lights to dim. To increase the
brightness, refer to “Lights” in “Understanding The
Features Of Your Vehicle.”
Key-Off Power Delay
When this feature is selected, the power window
switches, radio, Uconnect威 phone (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position.
Opening either front vehicle door will cancel this feature.
To make your selection, press the SELECT button until
Off, 45 sec., 5 min., or 10 min. appears.
Illumin. Approach
When this feature is selected, the headlights will activate
and remain on for up to 90 seconds when the doors are
unlocked with the remote keyless entry transmitter. To
make your selection, press the SELECT button until
“OFF,” “30 sec,” “60 sec,” or “90 sec” appears.
Display Units In
The EVIC and odometer can be changed between English
and Metric units of measure. To make your selection,
press and release the SELECT button until “U.S.” or
“METRIC” appears.
Compass Variance
Refer to “Compass Display” for more information.
Calibrate Compass
Refer to “Compass Display” for more information.
4
238 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK
Uconnect姞 730N/430/430N CD/DVD/HDD/NAV — IF
To set the analog clock, located at the top center of the EQUIPPED
instrument panel, press and hold the button in until the Refer to your Uconnect威 user’s manual for detailed
setting is correct. The clock will adjust slowly at first and operating instructions.
then quicker the longer the button is held.
Operating Instructions (Voice Command System)
— If Equipped
Refer to “Voice Command” for further details.
Operating Instructions (Uconnect姞 Phone) — If
Equipped
Refer to “Uconnect威 Phone” for further details.
Setting The Analog Clock
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 239
Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)
UCONNECT姞 130
Push the ON/VOLUME control knob to turn on the
radio. Push the ON/VOLUME control knob a second
time to turn off the radio.
Electronic Volume Control
The electronic volume control turns continuously (360
degrees) in either direction, without stopping. Turning
the ON/VOLUME control knob to the right increases the
volume, and to the left decreases it.
When the audio system is turned on, the sound will be
set at the same volume level as last played.
Uconnect威 130
SEEK Buttons
Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next
listenable station in AM/FM mode. Press the right switch
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC to seek up and the left switch to seek down. The radio
position to operate the radio.
will remain tuned to the new station until you make
Operating Instructions — Radio Mode
4
240 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
another selection. Holding either button will bypass 5. To exit, press any button/knob, or wait five seconds.
stations without stopping, until you release it.
RW/FF
TIME Button
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons
Press the TIME button to alternate display of the time causes the tuner to search for the next frequency in the
and radio frequency.
direction of the arrows. This feature operates in either
AM or FM frequencies.
Clock Setting Procedure
TUNE Control
1. Press and hold the TIME button until the hours blink.
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise
2. Adjust the hours by turning the right side TUNE/ to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the frequency.
SCROLL control knob.
Setting the Tone, Balance, and Fade
3. After adjusting the hours, press the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob to set the minutes. The minutes Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob and BASS
will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to
will begin to blink.
the right or left to increase or decrease the bass tones.
4. Adjust the minutes using the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to save time change.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 241
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a second Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob again to
time and MID will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL exit setting tone, balance, and fade.
control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
AM/FM Button
mid-range tones.
Press the buttons to select either AM or FM mode.
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a third
time and TREBLE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL SET/RND Button — To Set the Pushbutton
control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the Memory
treble tones.
When you are receiving a station that you wish to
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fourth commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET/RND
time and BALANCE will display. Turn the TUNE/ button. The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display
SCROLL control knob to the right or left to adjust the window. Select the button (1 to 6) you wish to lock onto
this station and press and release that button. If a button
sound level from the right or left side speakers.
is not selected within five seconds after pressing the
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fifth time SET/RND button, the station will continue to play but
and FADE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control will not be stored into pushbutton memory.
knob to the left or right to adjust the sound level between
You may add a second station to each pushbutton by
the front and rear speakers.
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET/RND button twice and SET 2 will show in the
4
242 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
display window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and
SET 2 in both AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM
and 12 FM stations to be stored into pushbutton memory.
The stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by
pressing the pushbutton twice.
Operation Instructions — CD MODE For CD And
MP3 Audio Play
NOTE:
• The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC position
to operate the radio.
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding
• This radio is capable of playing compact discs (CD),
button number will display.
recordable compact discs (CD-R), rewritable compact
Buttons 1 - 6
discs (CD-RW), compact discs with MP3 tracks and
These buttons tune the radio to the stations that you
multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks.
commit to pushbutton memory (12 AM and 12 FM
Inserting Compact Disc(s)
stations).
Gently insert one CD into the CD player with the CD
DISC Button
label facing up. The CD will automatically be pulled into
Pressing the DISC button will allow you to switch from the CD player and the CD icon will illuminate on the
AM/FM modes to Disc modes.
radio display. If a CD does not go into the slot more than
1.0 in (2.5 cm), a disc may already be loaded and must be
ejected before a new disc can be loaded.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 243
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio
ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and
begin to play when you insert the disc. The display will
show the track number, and index time in minutes and
seconds. Play will begin at the start of track 1.
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Dual-media disc types (one side is a DVD, the
other side is a CD) should not be used, and they can
cause damage to the player.
EJECT Button - Ejecting a CD
CAUTION!
• This CD player will accept 4–3/4 in (12 cm) discs
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the
CD player mechanism.
• Do not use adhesive labels. These labels can peel
away and jam the player mechanism.
• The Uconnect威 130 is a single CD player. Do not
attempt to insert a second CD if one is already
loaded.
(Continued)
Press the EJECT button to eject the CD.
If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within
10 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,
the radio will reinsert the CD but will not play it.
A disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.
NOTE: Ejecting with the ignition OFF is not allowed on
convertible or soft-top models (if equipped).
4
244 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
SEEK Button
AM/FM Button
Press the right SEEK button for the next selection on the
CD. Press the left SEEK button to return to the beginning
of the current selection, or return to the beginning of the
previous selection if the CD is within the first second of
the current selection. Pressing and holding the SEEK
button will allow faster scrolling through the tracks in
CD and MP3 modes.
Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
TIME Button
Press the right SEEK button to move to the next randomly selected track.
SET/RND Button (Random Play Button)
Press this button while the CD is playing to activate
Random Play. This feature plays the selections on the
compact disc in random order to provide an interesting
change of pace.
Press this button to change the display from a large CD
playing time display to a small CD playing time display. Press the RND button a second time to stop Random
Play.
RW/FF
Notes on Playing MP3 Files
Press and hold the FF (Fast Forward) button and the CD
player will begin to fast forward until FF is released, or The radio can play MP3 files; however, acceptable MP3 file
RW or another CD button is pressed. The RW (Reverse) recording media and formats are limited. When writing
MP3 files, pay attention to the following restrictions.
button works in a similar manner.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 245
Supported Media (Disc Types)
The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio are
CDDA, CD-R, CD-RW, MP3, and CDDA+MP3.
Supported Medium Formats (File Systems)
display the file name and folder name, and will assign
a number instead. With a maximum number of files,
exceeding 20 folders will result in this display. With
200 files, exceeding 50 folders will result in this
display.)
The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660 • Maximum number of characters in file/folder names:
Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension.
• Level 1: 12 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threeWhen reading discs recorded using formats other than
character extension)
ISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2, the radio may fail to read
• Level 2: 31 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threefiles properly and may be unable to play the file norcharacter extension)
mally. UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported.
Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio.
The radio uses the following limits for file systems:
Multisession discs may contain combinations of normal
• Maximum number of folder levels: 8
CD audio tracks and computer files (including MP3 files).
Discs created with an option such as ⬙keep disc open after
• Maximum number of files: 255
writing⬙ are most likely multisession discs. The use of
• Maximum number of folders. (The radio display of file multisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result in
names and folder names is limited. For large numbers longer disc loading times.
of files and/or folders, the radio may be unable to
4
246 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Supported MP3 File Formats
The radio will recognize only files with the *.MP3 extension as MP3 files. Non-MP3 files named with the *.MP3
extension may cause playback problems. The radio is
designed to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and will
not play the file.
MPEG
Specification
MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3
Sampling
Frequency
(kHz)
48, 44.1, 32
Bit Rate (kbps)
320, 256, 224,
192, 160, 128,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32
160, 128, 144,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32,
24, 16, 8
When using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data to
24, 22.05, 16
MPEG-2 Audio
an MP3 file, the bit rate and sampling frequencies in the
Layer
3
following table are supported. In addition, variable bit
rates (VBR) are also supported. The majority of MP3 files
use a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and a 192, 160, 128, 96 or
VBR bit rate.
ID3 Tag information for artist, song title, and album title
are supported for version 1 ID3 tags. ID3 version 2 is not
supported by the radios.
Playlist files are not supported. MP3 Pro files are not
supported.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 247
To increase the speed of disc loading, it is recommended
to use CD-R media and single-session discs. To create a
When a medium containing MP3 data is loaded, the
radio checks all files on the medium. If the medium single-session disc, enable the “Disc at Once” option
before writing to the disc.
contains a lot of folders or files, the radio will take more
time to start playing the MP3 files.
Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode
Playback of MP3 Files
Loading times for playback of MP3 files may be affected The auxiliary (AUX) jack is an audio input jack, which
allows the user to plug in a portable device, such as an
by the following:
MP3 player, or cassette player, and utilize the vehicle’s
• Media - CD-RW media may take longer to load than
audio system to amplify the source and play through the
CD-R media
vehicle speakers.
• Medium formats - Multisession discs may take longer Pressing the DISC/AUX button will change the mode to
to load than non-multisession discs
auxiliary device if the AUX jack is connected.
• Number of files and folders - Loading times will
increase with more files and folders
4
248 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The AUX device must be turned on and the UCONNECT姞 130 WITH SATELLITE RADIO
device’s volume set to proper level. If the AUX audio is
not loud enough, turn the device’s volume up. If the AUX
audio sounds distorted, turn the device’s volume down.
TIME Button (Auxiliary Mode)
Press this button to change the display to time of day. The
time of day will display for five seconds (when ignition is
OFF).
Uconnect威 130
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 249
Operating Instructions — Radio Mode
SEEK Buttons
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next
listenable station in AM/FM mode. Press the right switch
position to operate the radio.
to seek up and the left switch to seek down. The radio
Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)
will remain tuned to the new station until you make
Push the ON/VOLUME control knob to turn on the another selection. Holding either button will bypass
radio. Push the ON/VOLUME control knob a second stations without stopping, until you release it.
time to turn off the radio.
Voice Command System (Radio) — If Equipped
Electronic Volume Control
Refer to “Voice Command” in “Understanding The FeaThe electronic volume control turns continuously (360 tures If Your Vehicle”.
degrees) in either direction, without stopping. Turning
Voice Command Button Uconnect威 Phone — If
the ON/VOLUME control knob to the right increases the
Equipped
volume, and to the left decreases it.
Press this button to operate the Uconnect威 Phone feature
When the audio system is turned on, the sound will be (if equipped). Refer to “Uconnect威 Phone” in “Underset at the same volume level as last played.
standing The Features If Your Vehicle”.
4
250 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
If your vehicle is not equipped with or this feature is not Clock Setting Procedure
available on your vehicle, a “Not Equipped With
1. Press and hold the TIME button until the hours blink.
Uconnect Phone” message will display on the radio
2. Adjust the hours by turning the right side TUNE/
screen.
SCROLL control knob.
Phone Button Uconnect威 Phone — If Equipped
Press this button to operate the Uconnect威 Phone feature 3. After adjusting the hours, press the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob to set the minutes. The minutes
(if equipped). Refer to “Uconnect威 Phone” in “Underwill begin to blink.
standing The Features If Your Vehicle”.
If your vehicle is not equipped with or this feature is not 4. Adjust the minutes using the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL conavailable on your vehicle, a “Not Equipped With
trol knob to save time change.
Uconnect Phone” message will display on the radio
screen.
5. To exit, press any button/knob or wait five seconds.
The clock can also be set by pressing the SETUP button.
Press the TIME button to alternate display of the time For vehicles equipped with satellite radio, press the
SETUP button, use the TUNE/SCROLL control to select
and radio frequency.
SET CLOCK, and then follow the above procedure,
TIME Button
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 251
starting at Step 2. For vehicles not equipped with satellite Setting the Tone, Balance, and Fade
radio, press the SETUP button and then follow the above Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob and BASS
procedure, starting at Step 2.
will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to
the right or left to increase or decrease the bass tones.
INFO Button
Press the INFO button for an RDS station (one with call Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a second
letters displayed). The radio will return a Radio Text time and MID will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
message broadcast from an FM station (FM mode only). control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
mid-range tones.
RW/FF
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a third
causes the tuner to search for the next frequency in the time and TREBLE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
direction of the arrows. This feature operates in either control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
treble tones.
AM or FM frequencies.
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fourth
time and BALANCE will display. Turn the TUNE/
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise SCROLL control knob to the right or left to adjust the
to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the frequency. sound level from the right or left side speakers.
TUNE Control
4
252 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fifth time
and FADE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control
knob to the left or right to adjust the sound level between
the front and rear speakers.
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob again to
exit setting tone, balance, and fade.
MUSIC TYPE Button
Pressing this button once will turn on the Music Type
mode for five seconds. Pressing the MUSIC TYPE button
or turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob within five
seconds will allow the program format type to be selected. Many radio stations do not currently broadcast
Music Type information.
Toggle the MUSIC TYPE button to select the following
format types:
Program Type
No program type or
undefined
Adult Hits
Classical
Classic Rock
College
Country
Foreign Language
Information
Jazz
News
Nostalgia
Oldies
Personality
16-Digit Character
Display
None
Adlt Hit
Classicl
Cls Rock
College
Country
Language
Inform
Jazz
News
Nostalga
Oldies
Persnlty
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 253
Program Type
Public
Rhythm and Blues
Religious Music
Religious Talk
Rock
Soft
Soft Rock
Soft Rhythm and Blues
Sports
Talk
Top 40
Weather
16-Digit Character
Display
Public
R&B
Rel Musc
Rel Talk
Rock
Soft
Soft Rck
Soft R&B
Sports
Talk
Top 40
Weather
station with the same selected Music Type name. The
Music Type function only operates when in the FM
mode.
If a preset button is activated while in the Music Type
(Program Type) mode, the Music Type mode will be
exited and the radio will tune to the preset station.
SETUP Button
Pressing the SETUP button allows you to select between
the following items:
• Set Clock — Pressing the SELECT button will allow
you to set the clock. Adjust the hours by turning the
TUNE/SCROLL control knob. After adjusting the
hours, press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to set
the minutes. The minutes will begin to blink. Adjust
the minutes using the right side TUNE/SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to
By pressing the SEEK button when the Music Type icon
save time change.
is displayed, the radio will be tuned to the next frequency
4
254 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
AM/FM Button
Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
SET/RND Button — To Set the Pushbutton
Memory
When you are receiving a station that you wish to
commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET/RND
button. The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display
window. Select the button (1–6) you wish to lock onto this
station and press and release that button. If a button is
not selected within five seconds after pressing the SET/
RND button, the station will continue to play but will not
be stored into pushbutton memory.
You may add a second station to each pushbutton by
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET/RND button twice and SET 2 will show in the
display window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and
SET 2 in both AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM
and 12 FM stations to be stored into pushbutton memory.
The stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by
pressing the pushbutton twice.
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding
button number will display.
Buttons 1 - 6
These buttons tune the radio to the stations that you
commit to pushbutton memory (12 AM and 12 FM
stations).
DISC/AUX Button
Pressing the DISC/AUX button will allow you to switch
from AM/FM modes to DISC/AUX mode.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 255
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio
ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and
begin to play when you insert the disc. The display will
NOTE:
show the track number, and index time in minutes and
• The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC position seconds. Play will begin at the start of track 1.
to operate the radio.
Operation Instructions — CD MODE for CD and
MP3 Audio Play
• This radio is capable of playing compact discs (CD),
recordable compact discs (CD-R), rewritable compact
discs (CD-RW), compact discs with MP3 tracks and
multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks.
Inserting Compact Disc(s)
Gently insert one CD into the CD player with the CD
label facing up. The CD will automatically be pulled into
the CD player and the CD icon will illuminate on the
radio display. If a CD does not go into the slot more than
1.0 in (2.5 cm), a disc may already be loaded and must be
ejected before a new disc can be loaded.
CAUTION!
• This CD player will accept 4–3/4 in (12 cm) discs
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the
CD player mechanism.
• Do not use adhesive labels. These labels can peel
away and jam the player mechanism.
• The Uconnect威 130 is a single CD player. Do not
attempt to insert a second CD if one is already
loaded.
(Continued)
4
256 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Dual-media disc types (one side is a DVD, the
other side is a CD) should not be used, and they can
cause damage to the player.
EJECT Button - Ejecting a CD
Press the EJECT button to eject the CD.
SEEK Button
Press the right SEEK button for the next selection on the
CD. Press the left SEEK button to return to the beginning
of the current selection, or return to the beginning of the
previous selection if the CD is within the first second of
the current selection. Pressing and holding the SEEK
button will allow faster scrolling through the tracks in
CD and MP3 modes.
TIME Button
Press this button to change the display from a large CD
If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within playing time display to a small CD playing time display.
10 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,
RW/FF
the radio will reinsert the CD but will not play it.
Press and hold FF (Fast Forward) and the CD player will
A disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.
begin to fast forward until FF is released or RW or
NOTE: Ejecting with the ignition OFF is not allowed on another CD button is pressed. The RW (Reverse) button
convertible or soft-top models (if equipped).
works in a similar manner.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 257
AM/FM Button
Supported Media (Disc Types)
Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio are
CDDA, CD-R, CD-RW, MP3, and CDDA+MP3.
SET/RND Button (Random Play Button)
Supported Medium Formats (File Systems)
Press this button while the CD is playing to activate
Random Play. This feature plays the selections on the The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660
compact disc in random order to provide an interesting Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension.
change of pace.
When reading discs recorded using formats other than
ISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2, the radio may fail to read
Press the right SEEK button to move to the next ranfiles properly and may be unable to play the file nordomly selected track.
mally. UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported.
Press the SET/RND button a second time to stop RanThe radio uses the following limits for file systems:
dom Play.
• Maximum number of folder levels: 8
Notes On Playing MP3 Files
The radio can play MP3 files; however, acceptable MP3 file • Maximum number of files: 255
recording media and formats are limited. When writing
MP3 files, pay attention to the following restrictions.
4
258 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Maximum number of folders. (The radio display of file
names and folder names is limited. For large numbers
of files and/or folders, the radio may be unable to
display the file name and folder name, and will assign
a number instead. With a maximum number of files,
exceeding 20 folders will result in this display. With
200 files, exceeding 50 folders will result in this
display.)
writing⬙ are most likely multisession discs. The use of
multisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result in
longer disc loading times.
Supported MP3 File Formats
The radio will recognize only files with the *.MP3 extension as MP3 files. Non-MP3 files named with the *.MP3
extension may cause playback problems. The radio is
designed to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and will
not play the file.
• Maximum number of characters in file/folder names:
• Level 1: 12 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threeWhen using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data to
character extension)
an MP3 file, the bit rate and sampling frequencies in the
• Level 2: 31 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threefollowing table are supported. In addition, variable bit
character extension)
rates (VBR) are also supported. The majority of MP3 files
Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio. use a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and a 192, 160, 128, 96 or
Multisession discs may contain combinations of normal VBR bit rates.
CD audio tracks and computer files (including MP3 files).
Discs created with an option such as ⬙keep disc open after
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 259
MPEG
Specification
MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3
MPEG-2 Audio
Layer 3
Sampling
Frequency
(kHz)
48, 44.1, 32
24, 22.05, 16
Playback of MP3 Files
Bit Rate (kbps)
320, 256, 224,
192, 160, 128,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32
160, 128, 144,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32,
24, 16, 8
When a medium containing MP3 data is loaded, the
radio checks all files on the medium. If the medium
contains a lot of folders or files, the radio will take more
time to start playing the MP3 files.
Loading times for playback of MP3 files may be affected
by the following:
• Media - CD-RW media may take longer to load than
CD-R media
• Medium formats - Multisession discs may take longer
to load than non-multisession discs
ID3 Tag information for artist, song title, and album title
are supported for version 1 ID3 tags. ID3 version 2 is not • Number of files and folders - Loading times will
supported by the radios.
increase with more files and folders
Playlist files are not supported. MP3 Pro files are not
supported.
4
260 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
To increase the speed of disc loading, it is recommended
to use CD-R media and single-session discs. To create a
single-session disc, enable the “Disc at Once” option
before writing to the disc.
Press the INFO button once more to return to ⬙elapsed
time⬙ priority mode.
LIST Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play)
Press and hold the INFO button again for three seconds
to return to ⬙elapsed time⬙ display.
Pressing the LIST button will bring up a list of all folders
on the disc. Scrolling up or down the list is done by
turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob. Selecting a
folder by pressing the TUNE/SCROLL control knob will
begin playing the files contained in that folder (or the
next folder in sequence if the selection does not contain
playable files).
The folder list will time out after five seconds.
INFO Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play)
Pressing the INFO button repeatedly will scroll through
the following TAG information: Song Title, Artist, File
Name, and Folder Name (if available).
Press and hold the INFO button for three seconds or
more and the radio will display song titles for each file.
Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode
The auxiliary (AUX) jack is an audio input jack which
allows the user to plug in a portable device such as an
MP3 player or cassette player and utilize the vehicle’s
audio system to amplify the source and play through the
vehicle speakers.
Pressing the AUX button will change the mode to auxiliary device if the AUX jack is connected.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 261
NOTE: The AUX device must be turned on and the
device’s volume set to the proper level. If the AUX audio
is not loud enough, turn the device’s volume up. If the
AUX audio sounds distorted, turn the device’s volume
down.
NOTE: Sirius service is not available in Hawaii and has
limited coverage in Alaska.
System Activation
Sirius Satellite Radio service is pre-activated, and you
may begin listening immediately to the one year of audio
TIME Button (Auxiliary Mode)
service that is included with the factory-installed satellite
Press this button to change the display to time of day. The radio system in your vehicle. Sirius will supply a weltime of day will display for five seconds (when the come kit that contains general information, including
ignition is OFF).
how to setup your on-line listening account. For further
information, call the toll-free number 888-539-7474, or
Uconnect姞 (Satellite Radio) — If Equipped
visit the Sirius web site at www.sirius.com, or at
Satellite radio uses direct satellite-to-receiver broadcast- www.siriuscanada.ca for Canadian residents.
ing technology to provide clear digital sound, coast to
coast. The subscription service provider is Sirius Satellite
Radio. This service offers over 130 channels of music,
sports, news, entertainment, and programming for children, directly from its satellites and broadcasting studios.
4
262 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification
Number (ESN/SID)
Selecting Uconnect威 (Satellite) Mode
Press the SAT button until ⬙SAT⬙ appears in the display. A
Please have the following information available when CD may remain in the radio while in the Satellite radio
calling:
mode.
1. The Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification Satellite Antenna
Number (ESN/SID).
To ensure optimum reception, do not place items on the
roof around the rooftop antenna location. Metal objects
2. Your Vehicle Identification Number.
placed within the line of sight of the antenna will cause
To access the ESN/SID, refer to the following steps:
decreased performance. Larger luggage items such as
bikes should be placed as far rearward as possible, within
ESN/SID Access
the loading design of the rack. Do not place items directly
With the ignition switch in the ON/RUN or ACC posion or above the antenna.
tion and the radio on, press the SETUP button and scroll
using the TUNE/SCROLL control knob until Sirius ID is Reception Quality
selected. Press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob and the Satellite reception may be interrupted due to one of the
Sirius ID number will display. The Sirius ID number following reasons:
display will time out in two minutes. Press any button on
• The vehicle is parked in an underground parking
the radio to exit this screen.
structure or under a physical obstacle.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 263
• Dense tree coverage may interrupt reception in the remain tuned to the new channel until you make another
selection. Holding either button will bypass channels
form of short audio mutes.
without stopping until you release it.
• Driving under wide bridges or along tall buildings can
SCAN Button
cause intermittent reception.
• Placing objects over or too close to the antenna can Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search for
the next channel, pausing for eight seconds before concause signal blockage.
tinuing to the next. To stop the search, press the SCAN
Operating Instructions - Uconnect威 (Satellite)
button a second time.
Mode
INFO Button
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN or
Pressing the INFO button will cycle the display informaACC position to operate the radio.
tion between Artist, Song Title, and Composer (if availSEEK Buttons
able). Also, pressing and holding the INFO button for an
Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next additional three seconds will make the radio display the
channel in Satellite mode. Press the right switch to seek Song Title all of the time (press and hold again to return
up and the left switch to seek down. The radio will to normal display).
4
264 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
By pressing the SEEK button when the Music Type
function is active, the radio will be tuned to the next
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons
channel with the same selected Music Type name.
causes the tuner to search for the next channel in the
direction of the arrows.
If a preset button is activated while in the Music Type
(Program Type) mode, the Music Type mode will be
TUNE Control (Rotary)
exited and the radio will tune to the preset channel.
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise
to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the channel. SETUP Button
Pressing the SETUP button allows you to select the
MUSIC TYPE Button
following items:
Pressing this button once will turn on the Music Type
mode for five seconds. Pressing the MUSIC TYPE button • Display Sirius ID number — Press the AUDIO/
SELECT button to display the Sirius ID number. This
or turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob within five
number is used to activate, deactivate, or change the
seconds will allow the program format type to be seSirius subscription.
lected.
Toggle the MUSIC TYPE button again to select the music SET Button – To Set the Pushbutton Memory
RW/FF
type.
When you are receiving a channel that you wish to
commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET button.
The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display window.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 265
Select the button (1-6) you wish to lock onto this channel
and press and release that button. If a button is not
selected within five seconds after pressing the SET button, the channel will continue to play but will not be
stored into pushbutton memory.
You may add a second channel to each pushbutton by
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the display
window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2. This
allows a total of 12 Satellite channels to be stored into
pushbutton memory. The channels stored in SET 2
memory can be selected by pressing the pushbutton
twice.
Buttons 1 - 6
These buttons tune the radio to the channels that you
commit to pushbutton memory (12 Satellite stations).
Operating Instructions - Uconnect威 Phone (If
Equipped)
Refer to “Uconnect威 Phone” in “Understanding The
Features Of Your Vehicle”.
iPod姞/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
This feature allows an iPod威 or external USB device to be
plugged into the USB port, located in the center of the
instrument panel below the climate controls.
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding iPod威 control supports Mini, 4G, Photo, Nano, 5G iPod威
and iPhone威 devices. Some iPod威 software versions may
button number will display.
not fully support the iPod威 control features. Please visit
Apple’s website for software updates.
4
266 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:
• If the radio has a USB port, refer to the appropriate
Uconnect威 Multimedia radio User’s Manual for iPod威
or external USB device support capability.
• Connecting an iPod威 or consumer electronic audio
device to the AUX port located in the radio faceplate,
plays media, but does not use the iPod威 /MP3 control
feature to control the connected device.
Connecting The iPod姞 Or External USB Device
Use the connection cable to connect an iPod威 or external
USB Connector Port
USB device to the vehicle’s USB connector port which is
located in the center of the instrument panel below the Once the audio device is connected and synchronized to
climate controls.
the vehicle’s iPod威/USB/MP3 control system (iPod威 or
external USB device may take a few minutes to connect),
the audio device starts charging and is ready for use by
pressing radio switches, as described below.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 267
NOTE: If the audio device battery is completely discharged, it may not communicate with the iPod威/USB/
MP3 control system until a minimum charge is attained.
Leaving the audio device connected to the iPod威/USB/
MP3 control system may charge it to the required level.
Controlling The iPod姞 Or External USB Device
Using Radio Buttons
To get into the iPod威/USB/MP3 control mode and access
a connected audio device, either press the “AUX” button
on the radio faceplate or press the VR button and say
⬙USB⬙ or ⬙Switch to USB⬙. Once in the iPod威/USB/MP3
Using This Feature
control mode, audio tracks (if available from audio
By using iPod cable or external USB device to connect to
device) start playing over the vehicle’s audio system.
USB port:
Play Mode
• The audio device can be played on the vehicle’s sound
system, providing metadata (artist, track title, album, When switched to iPod威/USB/MP3 control mode, the
iPod威 or external USB device automatically starts Play
etc.) information on the radio display.
mode. In Play mode, the following buttons on the radio
• The audio device can be controlled using the radio faceplate may be used to control the iPod威 or external
buttons to Play, Browse, and List the iPod威 contents. USB device and display data:
• The audio device battery charges when plugged into • Use the TUNE control knob to select the next or
the USB/AUX connector (if supported by the specific
previous track.
audio device)
4
268 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Turning it clockwise (forward) by one click, while
during play mode will jump to the next track in the
playing a track, skips to the next track or press the
list, or press the VR button and say ⬙Next or Previous
VR button and say ⬙Next Track⬙.
Track⬙.
• Turning it counterclockwise (backward) by one click, • While a track is playing, press the INFO button to see
will jump to the previous track in the list or press the
the associated metadata (artist, track title, album, etc.)
VR button and say ⬙Previous Track⬙
for that track. Pressing the INFO button again jumps
• Jump backward in the current track by pressing and
to the next screen of data for that track. Once all
holding the << RW button. Holding the << RW
screens have been viewed, the last INFO button press
button long enough will jump to the beginning of the
will go back to the play mode screen on the radio.
current track.
• Pressing the REPEAT button will change the audio
• Jump forward in the current track by pressing and
device mode to repeat the current playing track or
holding the FF>> button.
press the VR button and say ⬙Repeat ON⬙ or ⬙Repeat
Off⬙.
• A single press backward << RW or forward FF>> will
jump backward or forward respectively, for five • Press the SCAN button to use iPod威/USB/MP3 deseconds.
vice scan mode, which will play the first 10 seconds of
each track in the current list and then forward to the
• Use the << SEEK and SEEK>> buttons to jump to the
next song. To stop SCAN mode and start playing the
previous or next track. Pressing the SEEK>> button
desired track, when it is playing the track, press the
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 269
SCAN button again. During Scan mode, pressing the
<< SEEK and SEEK>> buttons will select the previous
and next tracks.
• RND button (available on sales code RES radio only):
Pressing this button toggles between Shuffle ON and
Shuffle OFF modes for the iPod威 or external USB
device, or press the VR button and say ⬙Shuffle ON⬙ or
⬙Shuffle Off⬙. If the RND icon is showing on the radio
display, then the shuffle mode is ON.
List Or Browse Mode
During Play mode, pressing any of the buttons described
below, will bring up List mode. List mode enables
scrolling through the list of menus and tracks on the
audio device.
• TUNE control knob: The TUNE control knob functions
in a similar manner as the scroll wheel on the audio
device or external USB device.
• Turning it clockwise (forward) and counterclockwise
(backward) scrolls through the lists, displaying the
track detail on the radio display. Once the track to be
played is highlighted on the radio display, press the
TUNE control knob to select and start playing the
track. Turning the TUNE control knob fast will scroll
through the list faster. During fast scroll, a slight
delay in updating the information on the radio
display may be noticeable.
• During all List modes, the iPod威 displays all lists in
“wrap-around” mode. So if the track is at the bottom
of the list, just turn the wheel backward (counterclockwise) to get to the track faster.
• In List mode, the radio PRESET buttons are used as
shortcuts to the following lists on the iPod威 or
external USB device.
• Preset 1 – Playlists
• Preset 2 – Artists
• Preset 3 – Albums
4
270 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• MUSIC TYPE button: The MUSIC TYPE button is
• Preset 4 – Genres
another shortcut button to the genre listing on your
• Preset 5 – Audiobooks
audio device.
• Preset 6 – Podcasts
• Pressing a PRESET button will display the current
CAUTION!
list on the top line and the first item in that list on the
second line.
• Leaving the iPod威 or external USB device (or any
• To exit List mode without selecting a track, press the
supported device) anywhere in the vehicle in exsame PRESET button again to go back to Play mode.
treme heat or cold can alter the operation or damage the device. Follow the device manufacturer’s
guidelines.
• LIST button: The LIST button will display the top
• Placing items on the iPod威 or external USB device,
level menu of the iPod威 or external USB device. Turn
or connections to the iPod威 or external USB device
the TUNE control knob to list the top-menu item to be
in the vehicle, can cause damage to the device
selected and press the TUNE control knob. This will
and/or to the connectors.
display the next sub-menu list item on the audio
device, then follow the same steps to go to the desired
track in that list. Not all iPod威 or external USB device
sub-menu levels are available on this system.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 271
WARNING!
Do not plug in or remove the iPod威 or external USB
device while driving. Failure to follow this warning
could result in an accident.
Bluetooth Streaming Audio (BTSA)
device first, then it will get streamed to the Uconnect威
phone system. Seven devices can be paired to the
Uconnect威 phone system, but just one can be selected
and played.
Selecting Different Audio Device
1. Press PHONE button to begin.
Music can be streamed from your cellular phone to the 2. After the ⬙Ready⬙ prompt and the following beep, say
Uconnect威 phone system.
⬙Setup⬙, then ⬙Select Audio Devices⬙.
Controlling BTSA Using Radio Buttons
3. Say the name of the audio device or ask the Uconnect威
phone system to list audio devices.
To get into the BTSA mode, press either “AUX” button on
the radio or press the VR button and say “Bluetooth Next Track
Streaming Audio”.
Use the SEEK UP button, or press the VR button on the
Play Mode
radio and say “Next Track” to jump to the next track
When switched to BTSA mode, some audio devices can music on your cellular phone.
start playing music over the vehicle’s audio system, but
some devices require the music to be initiated on the
4
272 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Previous Track
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS — IF
Use the SEEK DOWN button, or press the VR button on EQUIPPED
the radio and say “Previous Track” to jump to the
previous track music on your cellular phone.
Browse
Browsing is not available on a BTSA device. Only the
current song that is playing will display info.
Remote Sound System Controls
(Back View Of Steering Wheel)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 273
The remote sound system controls are located on the rear Radio Operation
surface of the steering wheel, at the three and nine Pressing the top of the switch will SEEK up for the next
o’clock positions.
listenable station, and pressing the bottom of the switch
The right-hand rocker switch has a pushbutton in the will SEEK down for the next listenable station.
center, and controls the volume and mode of the sound The button located in the center of the left-hand switch
system. Pressing the top of the rocker switch will increase will tune to the next preset station that you have prothe volume. Pressing the bottom of the rocker switch will grammed in the radio preset pushbutton.
decrease the volume. Pressing the center button changes
the operation of the radio from AM to FM, or to CD CD Player
mode, depending on which radio is in the vehicle.
Pressing the top of the switch once will go to the next
The left-hand rocker switch has a pushbutton in the track on the CD. Pressing the bottom of the switch once
center. The function of the left-hand switch is different, will go to the beginning of the current track, or to the
beginning of the previous track if it is within one second
depending on which mode you are in.
after the current track begins to play.
The following describes the left-hand rocker switch opIf you press the switch up or down twice it plays the
eration in each mode.
second track; three times, it will play the third, etc.
The button in the center of the left-hand switch has no
function in this mode.
4
274 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particuTo keep a CD/DVD in good condition, take the following lar disc, it may be damaged (i.e., scratched, reflective
coating removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc)
precautions:
oversized, or have protection encoding. Try a known
1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the good disc before considering disc player service.
surface.
RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
wiping from center to edge.
your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
3. Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratch- your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
ing the disc.
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
4. Do not use solvents such as benzene, thinner, cleaners, not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
or anti-static sprays.
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
5. Store the disc in its case after playing.
turned down or off during mobile phone operation when
not using Uconnect威 (if equipped).
6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.
CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE
7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may become
too high.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 275
The Manual Temperature Controls consist of a series of
The air conditioning and heating system is designed to outer rotary dials and inner push knobs.
make you comfortable in all types of weather.
Blower Control
CLIMATE CONTROLS
Manual Heating And Air Conditioning
Rotate this control to regulate the
amount of air forced through the ventilation system in any mode. The
blower speed increases as you move
the control to the right from the “O”
(OFF) position. There are four blower
speeds.
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Remote Start, the
climate controls will not function during Remote Start
operation if the blower control is left in the “O” (Off)
position.
Manual Temperature Control
4
276 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Temperature Control
Rotate this control to regulate the temperature of the air inside the passenger
compartment. Rotating the dial left
into the blue area of the scale indicates
cooler temperatures, while rotating
right into the red area indicates
warmer temperatures.
Mode Control (Air Direction)
Rotate this control to choose from several patterns of air distribution. You
can select either a primary mode as
identified by the symbols on the control, or a blend of two of these modes.
The closer the setting is to a particular
symbol, the more air distribution you
receive from that mode.
NOTE: If your air conditioning performance seems
lower than expected, check the front of the A/C con- • Panel
denser located in front of the radiator for an accumulaAir is directed through the outlets in the instrution of dirt or insects. Clean with a gentle water spray
ment panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
from behind the radiator and through the condenser. airflow.
Fabric front fascia protectors may reduce airflow to the
NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed
condenser, reducing air conditioning performance.
so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers
for maximum airflow to the rear.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 277
• Bi-Level
• Defrost
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
Air is directed through the windshield and side
window demist outlets. Use this mode with maxiNOTE: For all settings, except full cold or full hot,
mum blower and temperature settings for best windthere is a difference in temperature between the upper
shield and side window defrosting.
and lower outlets. The warmer air flows to the floor
outlets. This feature gives improved comfort during NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in Mix,
Defrost, or a blend of these modes, even if the Air
sunny but cool conditions.
Conditioning (A/C) button is not pressed. This dehu• Floor
midifies the air to help dry the windshield. To improve
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a fuel economy, use these modes only when necessary.
small amount flowing through the defrost and
• Recirculation Control
side window demist outlets.
Pressing the Recirculation Control button will
• Mix
temporarily put the system in recirculation
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
mode. This can be used when outside condiwindow demist outlets. This setting works best in
tions such as smoke, odors, dust, or high
cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the humidity are present. Activating recirculation will cause
windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort the LED in the control button to illuminate.
while reducing moisture on the windshield.
4
278 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:
• The A/C can be deselected manually without disturbing the mode control selection.
• Continuous use of the Recirculation mode may make
the inside air stuffy and window fogging may occur. • When the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
Extended use of this mode is not recommended.
position, the recirculation feature will be cancelled.
• The use of the Recirculation mode in cold or damp
weather will cause windows to fog on the inside, Air Conditioning Control
because of moisture buildup inside the vehicle. Select
the outside air position for maximum defogging.
Press this button to engage the Air Conditioning. A light will illuminate when
• The A/C will engage automatically to prevent fogging
the Air Conditioning system is engaged.
when the recirculation button is pressed and the mode
Rotating the dial left into the blue area
control is set to panel or Bi-Level.
of the scale indicates cooler tempera• Recirculated air is not allowed in Defrost modes. If the
tures, while rotating right into the red
Recirculation button is pressed while in Defrost mode,
area indicates warmer temperatures.
the LED indicator will flash several times then go out.
Recirculation will be disabled automatically when NOTE: The air conditioning compressor will not engage
until the engine has been running for about 10 seconds.
Defrost mode is selected.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 279
• MAX A/C
For maximum cooling use the A/C and recirculation
buttons at the same time.
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) — If
Equipped
• ECONOMY MODE
If economy mode is desired, press the A/C button to turn
OFF the indicator light and the A/C compressor. Then,
move the temperature control to the desired temperature.
4
Automatic Temperature Control
280 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Automatic Operation
The Automatic Temperature Control system automatically maintains the climate in the cabin of the vehicle at
the comfort levels desired by the driver and passenger.
Operation of the system is quite simple.
You will experience the greatest efficiency by simply allowing the system
to function automatically. Selecting the
“O” (OFF) position on the blower control stops the system completely and
closes the outside air intake.
1. Turn the Mode Control knob (on the right) and the 72°F (22°C) is the recommended setting for maximum
Blower Control knob (on the left) to AUTO
comfort for the average person; however, this may vary.
NOTE: The AUTO position performs best for front seat NOTE:
occupants only.
• The temperature setting can be adjusted at anytime
2. Dial in the temperature you would like the system to
without affecting automatic operation.
maintain by rotating the Temperature Control knob.
Once the comfort level is selected, the system will • Pressing the Air Conditioning Control button while in
AUTO mode will cause the LED in the control button
maintain that level automatically using the heating
to flash three times and then turn off. This indicates
system. Should the desired comfort level require air
that the system is in AUTO mode and requesting the
conditioning, the system will automatically make the
air conditioning is not necessary.
adjustment.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 281
• If your air conditioning performance seems lower than Blower Control
expected, check the front of the A/C condenser located
in front of the radiator for an accumulation of dirt or
For full automatic operation or for
insects. Clean with a gentle water spray from behind
automatic blower operation, turn the
the radiator and through the condenser. Fabric front
knob to the AUTO position. In manual
fascia protectors may reduce airflow to the condenser,
mode there are seven blower speeds
reducing air conditioning performance.
that can be individual selected. In off
position the blower will shut off.
• While operating in AUTO, the system will not automatically sense the presence of fog, mist or ice on the
windshield. The defrost mode must be manually selected to clear the windshield and side glass.
4
282 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Manual Operation
This system offers a full complement of manual override
features, which consist of Blower Preferred Automatic,
Mode Preferred Automatic, or Blower and Mode Preferred Automatic. This means the operator can override
the blower, the mode, or both. There is a manual blower
range for times when the AUTO setting is not desired.
The blower can be set to any fixed blower speed by
rotating the Blower Control knob (on the left).
NOTE: Please read the Automatic Temperature Control
Operation Chart that follows for details.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 283
4
284 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The operator can override the AUTO mode setting to • Floor
change airflow distribution by rotating the Mode Control
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a
knob (on the right) to one of the following positions.
small amount flowing through the defrost and
• Panel
side window demist outlets.
Air is directed through the outlets in the instru- • Mix
ment panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
airflow.
window demist outlets. This setting works best in
NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the
so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort
for maximum airflow to the rear.
while reducing moisture on the windshield.
• Bi-Level
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
• Defrost
Air is directed through the windshield and side
window demist outlets. Use this mode with maxiNOTE: For all settings, except full cold or full hot,
mum blower and temperature settings for best windthere is a difference in temperature between the upper
shield and side window defrosting.
and lower outlets. The warmer air flows to the floor
outlets. This feature gives improved comfort during
sunny but cool conditions.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 285
• Air Conditioner Control
NOTE:
Press this button to turn on the air • When the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
position, the recirculation feature will be cancelled.
conditioning during manual operation
only. When the air conditioning is
• In cold weather, use of the Recirculation mode may
turned on, cool dehumidified air will
lead to excessive window fogging. The Recirculation
flow through the outlets selected with
mode is not allowed in defrost, in order to improve
the Mode control dial. Press this butwindow clearing. Recirculation will be disabled autoton a second time to turn OFF the air
matically if Defrost is selected.
conditioning. An LED in the button illuminates when
• Extended use of recirculation may cause the windows
manual compressor operation is selected.
to fog. If the interior of the windows begins to fog,
• Recirculation Control
press the Recirculation button to return to outside air.
The system will automatically control recircuSome temp/humidity conditions will cause captured
lation. However, pressing the Recirculation
interior air to condense on windows and hamper
Control button will temporarily put the system
visibility. For this reason, the system will not allow
in recirculation mode. This can be used when
Recirculation to be selected while in defrost. Attemptoutside conditions such as smoke, odors, dust, or high
ing to use the recirculation while in Defrost will cause
humidity are present. Activating recirculation will cause
the LED in the control button to blink and then turn
the LED in the control button to illuminate.
off.
4
286 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Most of the time, when in Automatic Operation, you
can temporarily put the system into Recirculation
Mode by pressing the Recirculation button. However,
under certain conditions, while in Automatic Mode,
the system is blowing air out the defrost vents. When
these conditions are present, and the Recirculation
button is pressed, the indicator will flash and then turn
off. This tells you that you are unable to go into
Recirculation Mode at this time. If you would like the
system to go into Recirculation Mode, you must first
move the Mode knob to Panel, Mix and then press the
Recirculation button. This feature reduces the possibility of window fogging.
Operating Tips
Summer Operation
The engine cooling system in air-conditioned vehicles
must be protected with a high-quality antifreeze coolant
to provide proper corrosion protection and to protect
against engine overheating. A solution of 50% ethylene
glycol antifreeze coolant and 50% water is recommended.
Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your
Vehicle” for proper coolant selection.
Winter Operation
Use of the air Recirculation Mode during winter months
is not recommended because it may cause window
fogging.
Vacation Storage
Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of service
NOTE: Refer to the chart at the end of this section for (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air
suggested control settings for various weather conditions. conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the
fresh air and high blower settings. This will ensure
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 287
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility Outside Air Intake
of compressor damage when the system is started again. Make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the
windshield, is free of obstructions such as leaves. Leaves
Window Fogging
collected in the air intake may reduce airflow, and if they
Interior fogging on the windshield can be quickly removed enter the plenum, they could plug the water drains. In
by turning the mode selector to Defrost. The Mix mode can winter months, make sure the air intake is clear of ice, slush,
be used to maintain a clear windshield and provide suffi- and snow.
cient heating. If side window fogging becomes a problem,
increase blower speed. Vehicle windows tend to fog on the A/C Air Filter — If Equipped
inside in mild but rainy or humid weather.
The A/C Filter prevents most dust and pollen from entering
NOTE: Recirculate without A/C should not be used for the cabin. The filter acts on air coming from outside the
vehicle and recirculated air within the passenger compartlong periods as fogging may occur.
ment. Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining
Side Window Demisters
Your Vehicle” for A/C Air Filter service information or see
A side window demister outlet is located at each end of the your authorized dealer for service. Refer to “Maintenance
instrument panel. These non-adjustable outlets direct air Schedules” for filter service intervals.
toward the side windows when the system is in the FLOOR,
MIX, or DEFROST mode. The air is directed at the area of
the windows through which you view the outside mirrors.
4
288 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Control Setting Suggestions for Various Weather Conditions
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
▫ Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System . . .301
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
▫ Four-Speed Automatic Transmission — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
▫ Extreme Cold Weather
(Below –20°F Or −29°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
▫ If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
▫ After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
䡵 ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED . . .298
䡵 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
▫ Key Ignition Park Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
▫ Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
▫ Six-Speed Automatic Transmission
(62TE) — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
▫ Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
䡵 AUTOSTICK威 — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . .316
▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . . . .318
5
290 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
䡵 POWER STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
䡵 ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) . . . . . . . . .324
䡵 ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .327
▫ Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . .327
▫ Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . .328
▫ Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
▫ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . .329
▫ ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .337
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .338
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .339
䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION. . . . . . . . .344
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
▫ All Season Tires – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .347
▫ Summer Or Three Season Tires – If Equipped . . .348
STARTING AND OPERATING 291
▫ Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
▫ Base System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358
▫ Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
Wheel – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
▫ Premium System – If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . .360
▫ Compact Spare Tire – If Equipped . . . . . . . . .349
▫ Full Size Spare – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
▫ Limited-Use Spare – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . .350
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . .354
䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .355
䡵 TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS) . .356
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
▫ E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles . . . . . . .366
▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
▫ Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
5
292 STARTING AND OPERATING
䡵 FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
▫ E-85 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
▫ Ethanol Fuel (E-85) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
▫ Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
▫ Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel
Vehicles (E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles . . . . . . .371
▫ Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
▫ Cruising Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
▫ Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
▫ Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
䡵 ADDING FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
▫ Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
▫ Loose Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
䡵 VEHICLE LOADING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
▫ Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
▫ Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) . . . . . . .376
▫ Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) . . . . . . . . .376
▫ Overloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
▫ Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
▫ Common Towing Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
▫ Trailer Hitch Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
▫ Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer
Weight Ratings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
▫ Trailer And Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
STARTING AND OPERATING 293
▫ Towing Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
▫ Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .389
▫ Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
▫ Recreational Towing – All Models . . . . . . . . . .389
䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
5
294 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING PROCEDURES
WARNING! (Continued)
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust the
inside and outside mirrors, fasten your seat belt, and if
present, instruct all other occupants to buckle their seat
belts.
WARNING!
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
Automatic Transmission
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
(Continued)
The shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL or PARK
position before you can start the engine. Apply the brakes
before shifting into any driving gear.
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 295
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Do not shift from REVERSE, PARK, or NEUTRAL
into any forward gear when the engine is above
idle speed.
• Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to
a complete stop.
• Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle
has come to a complete stop and the engine is at
idle speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly on the brake pedal.
Normal Starting
position and release it when the engine starts. If the
engine fails to start within 10 seconds, turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then
repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
For vehicles equipped with Tip Start (Six-Speed Transmission), turn the ignition switch to the START position
and release it as soon as the starter engages. The starter
motor will continue to run, and it will disengage automatically when the engine is running. If the engine fails
to start, the starter will disengage automatically in 10
seconds. If this occurs, turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then repeat the
“Normal Starting” procedure.
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm Extreme Cold Weather (Below –20°F Or −29°C)
engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the To ensure reliable starting at these temperatures, use of
accelerator pedal.
an externally powered electric engine block heater (availFor vehicles not equipped with Tip Start (Four-Speed able from your authorized dealer) is recommended.
Transmission), turn the ignition switch to the START
5
296 STARTING AND OPERATING
If Engine Fails To Start
WARNING!
• Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the
throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start
the vehicle. This could result in flash fire causing
serious personal injury.
• Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel
could enter the catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and damage the converter
and vehicle.
WARNING! (Continued)
• If the vehicle has a discharged battery, booster
cables may be used to obtain a start from a booster
battery or the battery in another vehicle. This type
of start can be dangerous if done improperly. Refer
to “Jump Starting” in “What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
Without Tip Start
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the
“Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures, it may be flooded. Push the accelerator pedal all
the way to the floor and hold it there while cranking the
engine. This should clear any excess fuel in case the
engine is flooded.
STARTING AND OPERATING 297
CAUTION!
To prevent damage to the starter, do not crank the
engine for more than 15 seconds at a time. Wait 10 to
15 seconds before trying again.
If the engine is flooded, it may start to run, but not have
enough power to continue running when the key is
released. If this occurs, continue cranking up to 15
seconds with the accelerator pedal pushed all the way to
the floor.
If the engine shows no sign of starting after two 15second periods of cranking with the accelerator pedal
held to the floor, repeat the “Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures.
With Tip Start
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the
“Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures, it may be flooded. To clear any excess fuel, push
the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it.
Then, turn the ignition switch to the START position and
release it as soon as the starter engages. The starter motor
will disengage automatically in 10 seconds. Once this
occurs, release the accelerator pedal, turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then
repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
CAUTION!
To prevent damage to the starter, wait 10 to 15
seconds before trying again.
5
298 STARTING AND OPERATING
After Starting
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will
decrease as the engine warms up.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED
WARNING!
Remember to disconnect the engine block heater
cord before driving. Damage to the 110-115 Volt
electrical cord could cause electrocution.
The engine block heater warms the engine, and permits
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
quicker starts in cold weather. Connect the cord to a
standard 110-115 Volt AC electrical outlet with a
CAUTION!
grounded, three-wire extension cord.
The engine block heater must be plugged in at least one Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
hour to have an adequate warning effect on the engine.
• Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to
The engine block heater cord is bundled under the hood
a complete stop.
between the headlight assembly and the Totally Inte- • Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle
grated Power Module (Fuse Box) on the driver’s side of
has come to a complete stop and the engine is at
the vehicle.
idle speed.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 299
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Do not shift between PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, or DRIVE when the engine is above idle
speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly pressing on the brake pedal.
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing on the brake pedal,
the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in
reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and
hit someone or something. Only shift into gear
when the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing on the brake pedal.
NOTE: You MUST press and hold the brake pedal while
shifting out of PARK.
(Continued)
5
300 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in and near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the shift lever is locked in
PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted
movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 301
out of PARK, the ignition switch must be turned to the
ON/RUN position (engine running or not) and the brake
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interpedal must be pressed.
lock which requires the shift lever to be placed in PARK
before the ignition switch can be turned to the LOCK/ Four-Speed Automatic Transmission — If
OFF position. The key can only be removed from the Equipped
ignition when the ignition is in the LOCK/OFF position,
The shift lever position display (located in the instrument
and once removed, the shift lever is locked in PARK.
cluster) indicates the transmission gear range. You must
NOTE: If a malfunction occurs, the system will trap the press the brake pedal to move the shift lever out of PARK
key in the ignition switch to warn you that this safety (refer to “Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in
feature is inoperable. The engine can be started and this section). To drive, move the shift lever from PARK or
stopped but the key cannot be removed until you obtain NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position.
service.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
Key Ignition Park Interlock
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
This vehicle is equipped with a Brake Transmission Shift
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
Interlock system (BTSI) that holds the shift lever in PARK
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
unless the brakes are applied. To shift the transmission
hundred miles (kilometers).
Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
5
302 STARTING AND OPERATING
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the When parking on a level surface, you may place the shift
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped. lever in PARK first, and then apply the parking brake.
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
moving the shift lever between these gears.
placing the shift lever in PARK, otherwise the load on the
transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to
Gear Ranges
move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precauDO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or
tion, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating.
WARNING!
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
PARK
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle moveThis range supplements the parking brake by locking the
ment and possible injury or damage.
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
(Continued)
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
STARTING AND OPERATING 303
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not completely in PARK. Check by trying to
move the shift lever rearward (with the brake pedal
released) after you have placed it in PARK. Make
sure the transmission is in PARK before leaving
the vehicle.
• It is dangerous to move the shift lever out of PARK
or NEUTRAL if the engine speed is higher than
idle speed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the
brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly
forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the
vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift
into gear when the engine is idling normally and
your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
and remove the ignition key. Once the key is
removed, the shift lever is locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
(Continued)
(Continued)
5
304 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION!
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle. Never
leave children alone in a vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to be in a
vehicle unattended is dangerous for a number of
reasons. A child or others could be seriously or
fatally injured. Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake, brake pedal or the shift
lever.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
• Before moving the shift lever out of PARK, you
must turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the ON/RUN position, and also press the
brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the shift lever
could result.
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from
PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this
can damage the drivetrain.
The following indicators should be used to ensure that
you have engaged the shift lever into the PARK position:
• When shifting into PARK, firmly move the shift lever
all the way forward and to the left until it stops and is
fully seated.
• Look at the shift lever position display and verify that
it indicates the PARK position.
STARTING AND OPERATING 305
• With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever
will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
periods with the engine running. The engine may be
started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift
the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
(Continued)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
5
306 STARTING AND OPERATING
automatically upshifts through all forward gears. The achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of the torque
DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteris- converter clutch is inhibited until the transmission fluid
is warm (refer to the “Note” under “Torque Converter
tics under all normal operating conditions.
Clutch” in this section). During extremely cold temperaWhen frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
tures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading condilimited to second gear only. Normal operation will retions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or
sume once the transmission temperature has risen to a
while towing heavy trailers), select the ⬙3⬙ range. Under
suitable level.
these conditions, using the ⬙3⬙ range will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing exces- DRIVE 3
sive shifting and heat buildup.
This range eliminates shifts into fourth gear. The transmission will operate normally in first and second gear.
Shifts into third may be delayed to provide second gear
operation at higher speeds. Using the ⬙3⬙ range while
operating the vehicle under heavy operating conditions
will improve performance and extend transmission life
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may by reducing excessive shifting and heat build-up. The ⬙3⬙
be modified depending on engine and transmission range should also be used when descending steep grades
temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature im- to avoid brake system distress.
proves warm up time of the engine and transmission to
If the transmission temperature exceeds normal operating limits, the powertrain controller will modify the
DRIVE and “3” range shift points. This is done to prevent
transmission damage due to overheating.
STARTING AND OPERATING 307
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission
can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the
Use this range for engine braking when descending very
following steps:
steep grades. In this range, the transmission will downshift for maximum engine braking, and upshifts will 1. Stop the vehicle.
occur only to prevent engine overspeed.
2. Shift the transmission into PARK.
Transmission Limp Home Mode
3. Turn the engine OFF.
Transmission function is monitored electronically for
abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could 4. Wait approximately 10 seconds.
result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home 5. Restart the engine.
Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains
in third gear regardless of which forward gear is selected. 6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal
PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operoperation.
ate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recomdriven to an authorized dealer for service without dam- mend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
aging the transmission.
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has
diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
recur.
LOW
5
308 STARTING AND OPERATING
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer Torque Converter Clutch
service is required.
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been
included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle. A
Overdrive Operation
clutch within the torque converter engages automatically at
The automatic transmission includes an electronically calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly different
controlled Overdrive (fourth gear). The transmission will feeling or response during normal operation in the upper
automatically shift into Overdrive if the following con- gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during some
ditions are present:
accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
• the shift lever is in the DRIVE position,
NOTE: The torque converter clutch will not engage until
the
transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm [usu• the transmission fluid has reached an adequate
ally
after 1 to 3 miles (2 to 5 km) of driving]. Because the
temperature,
engine speed is higher when the torque converter clutch is
• the engine coolant has reached an adequate not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission is not
temperature,
shifting into Overdrive when cold. This is normal. Shifting
between the DRIVE and 3 ranges, when the transmission is
• vehicle speed is sufficiently high, and
sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that the transmission is
• the driver is not heavily pressing the accelerator.
able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
STARTING AND OPERATING 309
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped.
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
The shift lever position display (located in the instrument
moving the shift lever between these gears.
cluster) indicates the transmission gear range. You must
press the brake pedal to move the shift lever out of PARK The transmission shift lever has PARK, REVERSE, NEU(refer to “Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in TRAL, DRIVE, and AutoStick威 shift positions. Manual
this section). To drive, move the shift lever from PARK or shifts can be made using the AutoStick威 shift control
(refer to “AutoStick威” in “Starting And Operating” for
NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position.
further information). Moving the shift lever to the left or
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
right (-/+) while in the AutoStick威 position (below the
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
Drive position) will manually select the transmission
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
gear, and will display the current gear in the instrument
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
cluster as 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1.
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
hundred miles (kilometers).
Six-Speed Automatic Transmission (62TE) — If
Equipped
5
310 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating.
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
PARK
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
Shift Lever
When parking on a level surface, you may place the shift
lever in PARK first, and then apply the parking brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
placing the shift lever in PARK, otherwise the load on the
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or
transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill
grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
Gear Ranges
STARTING AND OPERATING 311
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not completely in PARK. Check by trying to
move the shift lever rearward (with the brake pedal
released) after you have placed it in PARK. Make
sure the transmission is in PARK before leaving
the vehicle.
• It is dangerous to move the shift lever out of PARK
or NEUTRAL if the engine speed is higher than
idle speed. If your foot is not firmly pressing the
brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly
forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the
vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift
into gear when the engine is idling normally and
your foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
and remove the ignition key. Once the key is
removed, the shift lever is locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
(Continued)
(Continued)
5
312 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION!
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle. Never
leave children alone in a vehicle, or with access to
an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to be in a
vehicle unattended is dangerous for a number of
reasons. A child or others could be seriously or
fatally injured. Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake, brake pedal or the shift
lever.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
• Before moving the shift lever out of PARK, you
must turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the ON/RUN position, and also press the
brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the shift lever
could result.
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from
PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this
can damage the drivetrain.
The following indicators should be used to ensure that
you have engaged the shift lever into the PARK position:
• When shifting into PARK, firmly move the shift lever
all the way forward and to the left until it stops and is
fully seated.
• Look at the shift lever position display and verify that
it indicates the PARK position.
STARTING AND OPERATING 313
• With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever
will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
periods with the engine running. The engine may be
started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift
the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
(Continued)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
5
314 STARTING AND OPERATING
is warm (refer to the “Note” under “Torque Converter
Clutch” in this section). During extremely cold temperatures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be
limited to third gear only. Normal operation will resume
once the transmission temperature has risen to a suitable
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
level.
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or Transmission Limp Home Mode
while towing heavy trailers), use the AutoStick威 shift Transmission function is monitored electronically for
control (refer to “AutoStick威” in this section) to select a abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could
lower gear. Under these conditions, using a lower gear result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home
will improve performance and extend transmission life Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains
by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
in third gear regardless of which forward gear is selected.
automatically upshifts through underdrive first, second,
third, and fourth gears, direct fifth gear and overdrive
sixth gear. The DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may
be modified depending on engine and transmission
temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature improves warm up time of the engine and transmission to
achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of the torque
converter clutch is inhibited until the transmission fluid
PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be
driven to an authorized dealer for service without damaging the transmission.
STARTING AND OPERATING 315
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer
can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the service is required.
following steps:
Overdrive Operation
1. Stop the vehicle.
The automatic transmission includes an electronically
2. Shift the transmission into PARK.
3. Turn the engine OFF.
4. Wait approximately 10 seconds.
controlled Overdrive (sixth gear). The transmission will
automatically shift into the Overdrive gear if the following conditions are present:
• the shift lever is in the DRIVE position,
5. Restart the engine.
• the transmission fluid has reached an adequate
temperature,
6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal • the engine coolant has reached an adequate
operation.
temperature,
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recom- • vehicle speed is sufficiently high, and
mend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has • the driver is not heavily pressing the accelerator.
diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
recur.
5
316 STARTING AND OPERATING
Torque Converter Clutch
AUTOSTICK姞 — IF EQUIPPED
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been
included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle.
A clutch within the torque converter engages automatically at calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly
different feeling or response during normal operation in
the upper gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during
some accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
AutoStick威 is a driver-interactive transmission feature
providing manual shift control, giving you more control
of the vehicle. AutoStick威 allows you to maximize engine
braking, eliminate undesirable upshifts and downshifts,
and improve overall vehicle performance. This system
can also provide you with more control during passing,
city driving, cold slippery conditions, mountain driving,
and many other situations.
NOTE: The torque converter clutch will not engage until
the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm
[usually after 1 to 3 miles (2 to 5 km) of driving]. Because
the engine speed is higher when the torque converter
clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission
is not shifting into Overdrive when cold. This is normal.
Using the AutoStick威 shift control, when the transmission is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that the
transmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
Operation
When the shift lever is in the AutoStick威 position (below
the DRIVE position), it can be moved from side to side.
This allows the driver to manually select the transmission
gear being used. Moving the shift lever to the left (-)
triggers a downshift and to the right (+) an upshift. The
current gear will be displayed in the instrument cluster.
STARTING AND OPERATING 317
In AutoStick威 mode, the transmission will shift up or • If a downshift would cause the engine to over-speed,
down when the driver moves the shift lever to the right
that shift will not occur until it is safe for the engine
(+) or left (-), unless an engine lugging or overspeed
• Avoid using speed control when AutoStick威 is
condition would result. It will remain in the selected gear
engaged.
until another upshift or downshift is chosen, except as
described below.
• Transmission shifting will be more noticeable when
AutoStick威 is engaged.
• The transmission will automatically downshift to first
gear when coming to a stop. After a stop, the driver • If the system detects powertrain overheating, the
transmission will revert to the automatic shift mode
should manually upshift (+) the transmission as the
and remain in that mode until the powertrain cools off.
vehicle is accelerated.
• You can start out, from a stop, in any gear except top • If the system detects a problem, it will disable the
AutoStick威 mode and the transmission will return to
gear. Tapping (+) (at a stop) will allow starting in
the automatic mode until the problem is corrected.
second gear. Starting out in second gear is helpful in
snowy or icy conditions.
To disengage AutoStick威 mode, return the shift lever to
• The transmission will automatically upshift when nec- the DRIVE position. You can shift in or out of the
AutoStick威 position at any time without taking your foot
essary to prevent engine over-speed.
off the accelerator pedal.
5
318 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
WARNING!
Do not downshift for additional engine braking on a
slippery surface. The drive wheels could lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid, causing an accident
or personal injury.
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the
front wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle
and possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet, mud, loose sand, etc.).
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
Acceleration
Traction
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
the front (driving) wheels.
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road
surface. This is hydroplaning and may cause partial or
complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To
reduce this possibility, the following precautions should
be observed:
1. Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are
slushy.
STARTING AND OPERATING 319
2. Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles. Flowing/Rising Water
3. Replace the tires when tread wear indicators first
become visible.
4. Keep tires properly inflated.
5. Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
Driving through water more than a few inches/
centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure
Shallow Standing Water
safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
shallow standing water, consider the following Caution
and Warning before doing so.
5
320 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., engine oil, transmission, axle, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e.,
fluid that is milky or foamy in appearance) after
driving through standing water. Do not continue to
operate the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as this may result in further damage. Such
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and cause serious
internal damage to the engine. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 321
WARNING!
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and leave you
stranded.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
POWER STEERING
The standard power steering system will give you good
vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability
in tight spaces. The system will provide mechanical
steering capability if power assist is lost.
If for some reason the power assist is interrupted, it will
still be possible to steer your vehicle. Under these conditions, you will observe a substantial increase in steering
effort, especially at very low vehicle speeds and during
parking maneuvers.
NOTE:
• Increased noise levels at the end of the steering wheel
travel are considered normal and do not indicate that
there is a problem with the power steering system.
5
322 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Upon initial start-up in cold weather, the power steering pump may make noise for a short amount of time.
This is due to the cold, thick fluid in the steering
system. This noise should be considered normal, and it
does not in any way damage the steering system.
PARKING BRAKE
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
brake is fully applied. Also, be certain to leave the
transmission in PARK.
WARNING!
Continued operation with reduced power steering
assist could pose a safety risk to yourself and others.
Service should be obtained as soon as possible.
CAUTION!
Prolonged operation of the steering system at the end
of the steering wheel travel will increase the steering
fluid temperature and it should be avoided when
possible. Damage to the power steering pump may
occur.
Parking Brake
STARTING AND OPERATING 323
The parking brake lever is located in the center console.
To apply the parking brake, pull the lever up as firmly as
possible. To release the parking brake, pull the lever up
slightly, press the center button, then lower the lever
completely.
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
from the curb on an uphill grade. Apply the parking
brake before placing the shift lever in PARK, otherwise
the load on the transmission locking mechanism may
make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. The
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
parking brake should always be applied whenever the
switch ON, the “Brake Warning Light” in the instrument
driver is not in the vehicle.
cluster will illuminate.
NOTE:
• When the parking brake is applied and the transmission is placed in gear, the “Brake Warning Light” will
flash. If vehicle speed is detected, a chime will sound
to alert the driver. Fully release the parking brake
before attempting to move the vehicle.
• This light only shows that the parking brake is applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
5
WARNING!
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
(Continued)
324 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle or it may roll and cause damage or
injury. Also, be certain to leave the transmission in
PARK. Failure to do so may cause the vehicle to roll
and cause damage or injury.
CAUTION!
If the “Brake Warning Light” remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) provides increased
vehicle stability and brake performance under most
braking conditions. The system operates with a separate
computer to modulate the hydraulic pressure to prevent
wheel lock-up and avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
STARTING AND OPERATING 325
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Pumping of the anti-lock brakes will diminish
their effectiveness and may lead to a collision.
Pumping makes the stopping distance longer. Just
press firmly on your brake pedal when you need to
slow down or stop.
• The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase
braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded
by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or
the traction afforded.
• The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
(Continued)
The “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System. The light will
come on when the ignition switch is turned to
the ON position and may stay on for as long as
four seconds.
If the “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” remains on or
comes on while driving, it indicates that the anti-lock
portion of the brake system is not functioning and that
service is required. However, the conventional brake
system will continue to operate normally if the “Brake
Warning Light” is not on.
5
326 STARTING AND OPERATING
If the “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” is on, the brake
system should be serviced as soon as possible to restore
the benefits of anti-lock brakes. If the “Anti-Lock Brake
Warning Light” does not come on when the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position, have the bulb
repaired as soon as possible.
ABS is activated during braking under certain road or
stopping conditions. ABS-inducing conditions can include ice, snow, gravel, bumps, railroad tracks, loose
debris, or panic stops.
You also may experience the following when the brake
system goes into anti-lock:
If both the “Brake Warning Light” and the “Anti-Lock • The ABS motor running (it may continue to run for a
Brake Warning Light” remain on, the Anti-Lock Brake
short time after the stop),
(ABS) and Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD)
Systems are not functioning. Immediate repair to the ABS • the clicking sound of solenoid valves,
system is required. See your authorized dealer.
• brake pedal pulsations,
When the vehicle is driven over 7 mph (11 km/h), you • and a slight drop or fall away of the brake pedal at the
may hear a slight clicking sound as well as some related
end of the stop.
motor noises. These noises are the system performing its
These are all normal characteristics of ABS.
self-check cycle to ensure that the ABS system is working
properly. This self check occurs each time the vehicle is
started and accelerated past 7 mph (11 km/h).
STARTING AND OPERATING 327
WARNING!
The Anti-Lock Brake System contains sophisticated
electronic equipment that may be susceptible to
interference caused by improperly installed or high
output radio transmitting equipment. This interference can cause possible loss of anti-lock braking
capability. Installation of such equipment should be
performed by qualified professionals.
Control (ESC). All systems work together to enhance
vehicle stability and control in various driving conditions
and are commonly referred to as ESC.
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
This system aids the driver in maintaining vehicle control
under adverse braking conditions. The system controls
hydraulic brake pressure to prevent wheel lock-up and
help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces during braking.
Refer to “Anti-Lock Brake System” in “Starting and
All vehicle wheels and tires must be the same size and Operating” for further information.
type, and tires must be properly inflated to produce
accurate signals for the computer.
WARNING!
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
Your vehicle may be equipped with an optional advanced electronic brake control system that includes
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), Traction Control System
(TCS), Brake Assist System (BAS), and Electronic Stability
The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the
traction afforded by prevailing road conditions. The
(Continued)
5
328 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, driving on
very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must never be
exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
Traction Control System (TCS)
This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each of
the driven wheels. If wheel spin is detected, brake
pressure is applied to the slipping wheel(s) and engine
power is reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and
stability. A feature of the TCS system functions similar to
a limited slip differential and controls the wheel spin
across a driven axle. If one wheel on a driven axle is
spinning faster than the other, the system will apply the
brake of the spinning wheel. This will allow more engine
torque to be applied to the wheel that is not spinning.
This feature remains active even if TCS and ESC are in
the “Partial Off” mode. Refer to “Electronic Stability
Control (ESC)” in this section of this manual.
Brake Assist System (BAS)
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle’s braking
capability during emergency braking maneuvers. The system detects an emergency braking situation by sensing the
rate and amount of brake application and then applies
optimum pressure to the brakes. This can help reduce
braking distances. The BAS complements the Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS). Applying the brakes very quickly
results in the best BAS assistance. To receive the benefit of
the system, you must apply continuous braking pressure
during the stopping sequence. Do not reduce brake pedal
pressure unless braking is no longer desired. Once the brake
pedal is released, the BAS is deactivated.
STARTING AND OPERATING 329
WARNING!
• The BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase
braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the
condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the
traction afforded.
• The BAS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of a BAS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
This system enhances directional control and stability of
the vehicle under various driving conditions. ESC corrects for over/under steering of the vehicle by applying
the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting the over/under steer condition. Engine power
may also be reduced to help the vehicle maintain the
desired path. ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the vehicle path intended by the driver and compares it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual
path does not match the intended path, ESC applies the
brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting
the oversteer or understeer condition
• Over-steer - when the vehicle is turning more than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
• Under-steer - when the vehicle is turning less than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
5
330 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent the
natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle,
nor can it increase the traction afforded by prevailing
road conditions. ESC cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in
turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent accidents resulting
from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate
driver input for the conditions. Only a safe, attentive,
and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must never be
exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
ESC Operating Modes
All ESC equipped vehicles can choose the following ESC
operating modes:
ESC On
This is the normal operating mode for ESC. Whenever
the vehicle is started the ESC system will be in this mode.
This mode should be used for almost all driving situations. ESC should only be turned to “Partial Off” for
specific reasons as noted below.
Partial ESC Mode
This mode is entered by momentarily pressing the “ESC
Off” switch (located in the lower switch bank below the
heater/air conditioning controls). When in “Partial Off”
mode, the TCS portion of ESC, except for the limited slip
feature described in the TCS section, has been disabled
and the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light”
will be illuminated. All other stability features of ESC
STARTING AND OPERATING 331
function normally, with the exception of engine power To turn ESC on again, momentarily press the “ESC Off”
reduction. This mode is intended to be used if the vehicle switch. This will restore the normal “ESC On” mode of
is in deep snow, sand, or gravel conditions and more operation.
wheel spin than ESC would normally allow is required to
gain traction.
WARNING!
In partial ESC mode, the engine power reduction
feature of ESC is disabled. Therefore, enhanced
vehicle stability offered by the ESC system is reduced.
ESC Off Switch
5
332 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving
with snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or
gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the “Partial Off”
mode by pressing the “ESC Off” switch. Once the situation requiring ESC to be switched to the “Partial Off”
mode is overcome, turn ESC on again by momentarily
pressing the “ESC Off” switch. This may be done while
the vehicle is in motion.
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
ESC OFF Indicator Light
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
when the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position. It should go out with the engine running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light”
comes on continuously with the engine running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this light
remains on after several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has
been driven several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater
than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon
as possible to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” (located
in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as the tires
lose traction and the ESC system becomes active. The “ESC
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” also flashes when
TCS is active. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” begins to flash during acceleration, ease up on the
accelerator and apply as little throttle as possible. Be sure to
adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road conditions.
STARTING AND OPERATING 333
NOTE:
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
• The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” Tire Markings
and the “ESC OFF Indicator Light” come on momentarily each time the ignition switch is turned ON.
• Each time the ignition is turned ON, the ESC system
will be ON even if it was turned off previously.
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds
when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop
when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver that
caused the ESC activation.
5
The “ESC OFF Indicator Light” indicates the
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is off.
1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards
Code (TIN)
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
4 — Maximum Load
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
334 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Temporary spare tires are spares designed for temporary emergency use only. Temporary high pressure
• P (Passenger) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
compact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P”
into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Exmolded into the sidewall preceding the size designaample: T145/80D18 103M.
tion. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
• High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
• European-Metric tire sizing is based on European
standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
NOTE:
• LT (Light Truck) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
STARTING AND OPERATING 335
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Size Designation:
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards
T or S = Temporary spare tire
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
— Ratio of section height to section width of tire
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
R = Construction code
— ⬙R⬙ means radial construction
— ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
5
336 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
— A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
— A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
— The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
Load Identification:
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Absence of any text on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire
Extra Load (XL) = Extra load (or reinforced) tire
Light Load (LL) = Light load tire
C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load— Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure— Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for
this tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 337
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire,
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires with
white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the date
code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire. Look for
the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall tires as
mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on the
outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard side of
the tire.
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
— This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
—03 means the 3rd week.
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
—01 means the year 2001
— Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the
year in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
5
338 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located
behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after
the vehicle has not been driven for at least 3 hours, or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a three hour period. Inflation
pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per square inch) or
kPa (kilopascals).
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible
cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation
pressure is molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
A paper label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the
vehicle’s loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and
the recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
STARTING AND OPERATING 339
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
5
Tire Placard Location
340 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire And Loading Information Placard
3) tire size designed for your vehicle
4) cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard and in the “Vehicle Loading” section
of this manual.
Tire and Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about the:
1) number of people that can be carried in the vehicle
2) total weight your vehicle can carry
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
axles must not be exceeded. For further information on
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
“Vehicle Loading” in this section.
STARTING AND OPERATING 341
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
be five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed
is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 = 750, and 1400 – 750
the weight referenced here.
= 650 lbs [295 kg]).
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occusafely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
capacity calculated in Step 4.
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
manual to determine how this reduces the available
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pascargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
sengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
5
342 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
• The following table shows examples on how to calculate total load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities
of your vehicle with varying seating configurations
and number and size of occupants. This table is for
illustration purposes only and may not be accurate for
the seating and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
• For the following example, the combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs
(392 kg).
STARTING AND OPERATING 343
5
344 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Three primary
areas are affected by improper tire pressure:
Safety
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in over-heating and tire failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Over-inflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 345
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
stability of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of
sluggish response or over responsiveness in the steering.
Unequal tire pressures can cause erratic and unpredictable steering response.
Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the
vehicle to drift left or right.
Economy
Tire Inflation Pressures
Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wear
patterns to develop across the tire tread. These abnormal
wear patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need for
earlier tire replacement. Under-inflation also increases
tire rolling resistance resulting in higher fuel consumption.
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
driver’s side “B” Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side
door.
The tire pressure should be checked and adjusted as well
as inspected for signs of tire wear or visible damage at
least once a month. Use a good quality pocket-type gauge
to check tire pressure. Do not make a visual judgement
Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
when determining proper inflation. Radial tires may look
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
properly inflated even when they are under-inflated.
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
ride. Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the
5
346 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
which could damage the valve stem.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
the winter.
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
“cold tire inflation pressure.” Cold tire inflation pressure which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not outside temperature condition.
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1 Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
mile (1.6 km) after a three hour period. The cold tire during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
inflation pressure must not exceed the maximum infla- build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
tion pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditemperature changes.
tions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle
STARTING AND OPERATING 347
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle opera- Radial Ply Tires
tion. Refer to original equipment or an authorized tire
dealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loading
WARNING!
and cold tire inflation pressures.
Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
WARNING!
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. AlHigh speed driving with your vehicle under maxiways use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
mum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
combine them with other types of tires.
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the Cuts and punctures in radial tires are repairable only in
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above the tread area because of sidewall flexing. Consult your
authorized tire dealer for radial tire repairs.
75 mph (120 km/h).
All Season Tires – If Equipped
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (spring,
summer, fall and winter). Traction levels may vary between different all season tires. All season tires can be
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
5
348 STARTING AND OPERATING
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four; If you need snow tires, select tires equivalent in size and
failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires only
in sets of four; failure to do so may adversely affect the
handling of your vehicle.
safety and handling of your vehicle.
Summer Or Three Season Tires – If Equipped
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
on ice. Summer tires will not contain the all season
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
designation or mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
sidewall. Use summer tires only in sets of four; failure to
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
do so may adversely affect the safety and handling of
tire inflation pressures.
your vehicle.
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid
Snow Tires
and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states produring the winter. Snow tires can be identified by a hibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be
checked before using these tire types.
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall.
STARTING AND OPERATING 349
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
Wheel – If Equipped
CAUTION!
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
wheel equivalent in look and function to the original your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle compact, full size or limited-use temporary spare
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire installed. Damage to the vehicle may result.
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option
Compact Spare Tire – If Equipped
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only.
tire rotation pattern.
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a
If your vehicle is not equipped with an original equipcompact spare by looking at the spare tire description on
ment tire and wheel as a spare, a non-matching tempothe Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the
rary emergency use spare may be equipped with your
driver’s side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire.
vehicle. Temporary use spares are engineered to be used
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter “T”
only with your vehicle. Your vehicle may be equipped
or “S” preceding the size designation. Example: T145/
with one of the following types of non-matching tempo80D18 103M.
rary use spares; compact, full size, or limited-use. Do not
install more than one non-matching temporary use spare T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
tire/wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
5
350 STARTING AND OPERATING
Since this tire has limited tread life the original equip- Full Size Spare – If Equipped
ment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only.
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
This tire may look like the original equipped tire on the
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire. to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size
Do not install more than one compact spare tire and spare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
first opportunity.
WARNING!
Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
only. With these spares, do not drive more than
50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
Limited-Use Spare – If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
STARTING AND OPERATING 351
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the Tire Spinning
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not
first opportunity.
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopWARNING!
ping when you are stuck.
Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Installation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressure listed on
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side door opening. Replace (or repair)
the original equipment tire at the first opportunity
and reinstall it on your vehicle. Failure to do so could
result in loss of vehicle control.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
5
352 STARTING AND OPERATING
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
to help you in determining when your tires should be becomes 1/16 in (2 mm). When the tread is worn to the
tread wear indicators, the tire should be replaced.
replaced.
Life Of Tire
Tread Wear Indicators
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style
• Tire pressure
• Distance driven
• Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and summer tires, typically have a reduced
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle maintenance schedule is highly recommended.
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 353
WARNING!
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.
You could lose control and have a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
Information” placard for the size designation of your tire.
The Load Index and Speed Symbol for your tire will be
found on the original equipment tire sidewall. See the
Tire Sizing Chart example found in the Tire Safety
Information section of this manual for more information
relating to the Load Index and Speed Symbol of a tire.
It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
those of the original wheels.
Replacement Tires
It is recommended you contact your original equipment
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many or an authorized tire dealer with any questions you may
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for have on tire specifications or capability. Failure to use
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressure. The manu- equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the
facturer strongly recommends that you use tires equiva- safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
lent to the originals in size, quality and performance
when replacement is needed. (Refer to the paragraph on
“Tread Wear Indicators”). Refer to the “Tire and Loading
5
354 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
of unapproved tires and wheels may change suspension dimensions and performance characteristics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
(Continued)
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size may
result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Due to limited clearance, tire chains or traction devices
are not recommended.
CAUTION!
Damage to the vehicle may result if tire chains are
used.
STARTING AND OPERATING 355
The suggested rotation method is the “rearward cross”
shown in the following diagram. This rotation pattern
The tires on the front and rear of your vehicle operate at
does not apply to some directional tires that must not be
different loads and perform different steering, driving,
reversed.
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at
unequal rates.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a
smooth, quiet ride.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals. The reasons for any rapid or
unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being
performed.
5
Tire Rotation
356 STARTING AND OPERATING
also increase as the vehicle is driven - this is normal and
there should be no adjustment for this increased presThe Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the
sure.
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recommended cold placard pressure.
The TPM System will warn the driver of a low tire
pressure if the tire pressure falls below the low-pressure
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1
warning limit for any reason, including low temperature
psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (6.5°C). This means that when
effects and natural pressure loss through the tire.
the outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will
decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on The TPM System will continue to warn the driver of low tire
cold inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn off
pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended cold
three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a placard pressure. Once the low tire pressure warning (Tire
three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light) illuminates, you must
not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into increase the tire pressure to the recommended cold placard
the tire sidewall. Refer to “Tires – General Information” pressure in order for the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
in “Starting and Operating” for information on how to Light” to turn off. The system will automatically update
properly inflate the vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn
off once the system receives the updated tire pressures. The
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS)
STARTING AND OPERATING 357
vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this
information.
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended
cold (parked for more than three hours) placard pressure
of 30 psi (207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68°F
(20°C) and the measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa),
a temperature drop to 20°F (-7°C) will decrease the tire
pressure to approximately 23 psi (158 kPa). This tire
pressure is sufficiently low enough to turn ON the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light.” Driving the vehicle
may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately 27
psi (186 kPa), but the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will still be ON. In this situation, the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn OFF only
after the tires are inflated to the vehicle’s recommended
cold placard pressure value.
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire sealants
or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with a
TPMS, as damage to the sensors may result.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensor.
5
358 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure,
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
the tire.
and maintenance, or to provide warning of a tire
Base System
failure or condition.
NOTE:
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
while adjusting your tire pressure.
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. readings to the Receiver Module.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire
tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly
stopping ability.
and to maintain the proper pressure.
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain The TPMS consists of the following components:
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire pressure • Receiver Module
gauge, even if under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the “Tire Pressure Monitor- • Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
ing Telltale Light.”
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
STARTING AND OPERATING 359
Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
illuminate in the instrument cluster, a ⬙LOW
TIRE⬙ message will be displayed for a minimum of five
seconds and a chime will sound when tire pressure is low
in one or more of the four active road tires. Should this
occur, you should stop as soon as possible, check the
inflation pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate
each tire to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard
pressure value. Once the system receives the updated tire
pressures, the system will automatically update and the
“Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” and ⬙LOW
TIRE⬙ message will turn off. The vehicle may need to be
driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in
order for the TPMS to receive this information.
Check TPMS Warning
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash
on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid when
a system fault is detected. The system fault will also
sound a chime. If the ignition key is cycled, this sequence
will repeat, providing the system fault still exists. The
“Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off
when the fault condition no longer exists. A system fault
can occur due to any of the following:
1. Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
facilities emitting the same Radio Frequencies as the
TPM sensors.
2. Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting
that affects radio wave signals.
3. Lots of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel
housings.
5
360 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
NOTE:
4. For each subsequent ignition key cycle, a chime will
sound and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then
remain on solid.
1. The compact spare tire (if equipped) does not have a 5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire, and
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
tire pressure monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS
the TPMS will update automatically and the “Tire
will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare tire.
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn OFF, as
2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
long no tire pressure is below the low-pressure warntire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning limit in any of the four active road tires. The
ing limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, a chime will
vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes
sound and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to
Light” will turn ON and a ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will
receive this information.
be displayed for a minimum of five seconds.
Premium System – If Equipped
3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
then remain on solid.
STARTING AND OPERATING 361
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
readings to the Receiver Module.
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
illuminate in the instrument cluster and a chime
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly will sound when tire pressure is low in one or more of the
four active road tires. In addition, the Electronic Vehicle
and to maintain the proper pressure.
Information Center (EVIC) will display a graphic showThe TPMS consists of the following components:
ing the pressure values of each tire with the low tire
pressure values flashing.
• Receiver Module
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible,
and inflate all tires with low pressure (those flashing in
• Three Trigger Modules (mounted in three of the four
the EVIC graphic) to the vehicle’s recommended cold
wheel-wells)
placard pressure value. Once the system receives the
• Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System Messages, updated tire pressures, the system will automatically
which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information update, the graphic display in the EVIC will stop flashing, and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light”
Center (EVIC)
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
5
362 STARTING AND OPERATING
will turn off. The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 1. Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
facilities emitting the same Radio Frequencies as the
20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the
TPM sensors.
TPMS to receive this information.
Check TPMS Warning
2. Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting
that affects radio wave signals.
When a system fault is detected, a chime will sound and
the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash on 3. Lots of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel
and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. In
housings.
addition, the EVIC will display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYS4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
TEM⬙ message for a minimum of five seconds and then
display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value to 5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
indicate which sensor is not being received.
The EVIC will also display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙
If the ignition key is cycled, this sequence will repeat, message for a minimum of five seconds when a system
providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault fault related to an incorrect sensor location fault is
no longer exists, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale detected. In this case, the ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ mesLight” will no longer flash, and the ⬙CHECK TPM sage is then followed with a graphic display with presSYSTEM⬙ message will no longer display, and a pressure sure values still shown. This indicates that the pressure
value will display in place of the dashes. A system fault values are still being received from the TPM sensors but
can occur due to any of the following:
they may not be located in the correct vehicle position.
STARTING AND OPERATING 363
The system still needs to be serviced as long as the 3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ message is displayed.
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
NOTE:
then remain on solid. In addition, the EVIC will
display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ message for a
1. The compact spare tire (if so equipped) does not have
a tire pressure monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS
minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (- -)
in place of the pressure value.
will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare tire.
2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road 4. For each subsequent ignition key cycle, a chime will
sound, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light”
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warnwill flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on
ing limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will remain ON, a
solid, and the EVIC will display a ⬙CHECK TPM
SYSTEM⬙ message for a minimum of five seconds and
chime will sound, and the EVIC will still display a
then display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value.
flashing pressure value in the graphic display.
5
364 STARTING AND OPERATING
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire, and
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
the TPMS will update automatically. In addition, the
“Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn
OFF and the graphic in the EVIC will display a new
pressure value instead of dashes (- -), as long no tire
pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in
any of the four active road tires. The vehicle may need
to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this
information.
General Information
• This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
The tire pressure sensors are covered under one of the
following licenses:
United States
Canada
KR5S18002015B
267T-S180015B
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide excellent
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and
fuel economy and performance when usRSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
ing high-quality unleaded “regular” gasofollowing conditions:
line having an octane rating of 87. The use
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
of premium gasoline is not recommended, as it will not
provide any benefit over regular gasoline in these
engines.
STARTING AND OPERATING 365
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to
your engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at
high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is
required. Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such
as hard starting, stalling, and hesitations. If you experience these symptoms, try another brand of gasoline
before considering service for the vehicle.
Over 40 auto manufacturers worldwide have issued and
endorsed consistent gasoline specifications (the Worldwide Fuel Charter, WWFC) which define fuel properties
necessary to deliver enhanced emissions, performance,
and durability for your vehicle. The manufacturer recommends the use of gasolines that meet the WWFC specifications if they are available.
Reformulated Gasoline
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner
burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.”
Reformulated gasolines contain oxygenates and are specifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and improve air quality.
The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gasolines. Properly blended reformulated gasolines will provide excellent performance and durability of engine and
fuel system components.
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxygenates such as Ethanol. Fuels blended with oxygenates
may be used in your vehicle.
CAUTION!
DO NOT use gasoline containing Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol. Use of these
(Continued)
5
366 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
blends may result in starting and driveability problems, damage critical fuel system components, cause
emissions to exceed the applicable standard, and/or
cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light” to illuminate. Pump labels should clearly communicate if a
fuel contains greater than 10% Ethanol.
• operate in a lean mode
• OBD II “Malfunction Indicator Light” on
• poor engine performance
• poor cold start and cold drivability
• increased risk for fuel system component corrosion
To fix a Non-FFV vehicle inadvertently fueled once with
Problems that result from using gasoline containing E-85 perform the following:
Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol
• drain the fuel tank (see your authorized dealer)
are not the responsibility of the manufacturer and may
• change the engine oil and oil filter
not be covered under warranty.
E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles
• disconnect and reconnect the battery to reset the
engine controller memory
Non-FFV vehicles are compatible with gasoline containing 10% ethanol (E10). Gasoline with higher ethanol More extensive repairs will be required for prolonged
exposure to E-85 fuel.
content may void the vehicle’s warranty.
If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with E-85
fuel, the engine will have some or all of these symptoms:
STARTING AND OPERATING 367
MMT In Gasoline
Materials Added To Fuel
MMT is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is
blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline
blended with MMT provides no performance advantage
beyond gasoline of the same octane number without
MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug
life and reduces emissions system performance in some
vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline
without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content
of gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether
the gasoline contains MMT. It is even more important to
look for gasoline without MMT in Canada, because MMT
can be used at levels higher than those allowed in the
United States. MMT is prohibited in Federal and California reformulated gasoline.
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to
contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal
conditions and they would result in additional cost.
Therefore, you should not have to add anything to the
fuel.
Fuel System Cautions
5
CAUTION!
Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’s
performance:
• The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.
Using leaded gasoline can impair engine performance and damage the emissions control system.
(Continued)
368 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel or ignition
malfunctions can cause the catalytic converter to
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune
or malfunctioning and may require immediate service. Contact your authorized dealer for service
assistance.
• The use of fuel additives, which are now being
sold as octane enhancers, is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations
of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such
fuels or additives is not the responsibility of the
manufacturer.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control
system can result in civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas, which can
kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as
a garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running for an extended period. If the
vehicle is stopped in an open area with the engine
running for more than a short period, adjust the
ventilation system to force fresh, outside air into
the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 369
WARNING! (Continued)
• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper maintenance. Have the exhaust system inspected every
time the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal
conditions repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive
with all side windows fully open.
FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF
EQUIPPED
5
E-85 General Information
The information in this section is for Flexible Fuel vehicles only. These vehicles can be identified by a unique
fuel filler door label that states Ethanol (E-85) or Unleaded Gasoline Only. This section only covers those
subjects that are unique to these vehicles. Please refer to
the other sections of this manual for information on
features that are common between Flexible Fuel and
gasoline-only powered vehicles.
E-85 Fuel Cap
CAUTION!
Only vehicles with the E-85 fuel filler door label can
operate on E-85.
370 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Ethanol vapors are extremely flammable and could
cause serious personal injury. Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the vehicle when removing the fuel filler tube cap (gas cap) or filling the
tank. Do not use E-85 as a cleaning agent and never
use it near an open flame.
Fuel Requirements
E-85 Badge
Ethanol Fuel (E-85)
E-85 is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and
15% unleaded gasoline.
If your vehicle is E-85 compatible, it will operate on
unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87, or E-85
fuel, or any mixture of these two fuels.
STARTING AND OPERATING 371
For best results, a refueling pattern that avoids alternat- • Some additives used in regular gasoline are not fully
ing between E-85 and unleaded gasoline is recomcompatible with E-85 and may form deposits in your
engine. To eliminate driveability issues that may be
mended.
caused by these deposits, a supplemental gasoline
When you do switch fuel types it is recommended that:
additive, such as MOPAR威 Injector Cleanup or
• you do not add less than 5 gallons (19 Liters) when
Techron may be used.
refueling
Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles
• you drive the vehicle immediately after refueling for at (E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles
least 5 miles (8 km)
FFV vehicles operated on E-85 require specially formuObserving these precautions will avoid possible hard lated engine oils. These special requirements are included
starting and/or significant deterioration in driveability in MOPAR威 engine oils, and in equivalent oils meeting
during warm up.
Chrysler Specification MS-6395. The manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
NOTE:
the requirements of Material Standard MS-6395. MS-6395
• Use seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel (ASTM D5798). With contains additional requirements, developed during exnon-seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel, you may experience tensive fleet testing, to provide additional protection to
hard starting and rough idle following start up even if Chrysler Group LLC engines. Use MOPAR威 or an
the above recommendations are followed, especially equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
when the ambient temperature is below 32°F (0°C).
5
372 STARTING AND OPERATING
Starting
Replacement Parts
The characteristics of E-85 fuel make it unsuitable for use
when ambient temperatures fall below 0°F (-18°C). In the
range of 0°F (-18°C) to 32°F (0°C), you may experience an
increase in the time it takes for your engine to start, and
a deterioration in driveability (sags and/or hesitations)
until the engine is fully warmed up.
Many components in your Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV) are
designed to be compatible with ethanol. Always be sure
that your vehicle is serviced with correct ethanol compatible parts.
NOTE: Use of the engine block heater (if equipped) is
beneficial for E-85 startability when the ambient temperature is less than 32°F (0°C).
Replacing fuel system components with non-ethanol
compatible components can damage your vehicle.
Cruising Range
Because E-85 fuel contains less energy per gallon/liter
than gasoline, you will experience an increase in fuel
consumption. You can expect your miles per gallon
(mpg)/miles per liter and your driving range to decrease
by about 30%, compared to gasoline operation.
CAUTION!
Maintenance
CAUTION!
Do not use ethanol mixture greater than 85% in your
vehicle. It will cause difficulty in cold starting and
may affect driveability.
STARTING AND OPERATING 373
ADDING FUEL
Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap)
The gas cap is behind the fuel filler door, on the left rear
quarter panel of the vehicle. If the gas cap is lost or
damaged, be sure the replacement cap is for use with this
vehicle.
5
Fuel Filler Door
After removing the gas cap, place the gas cap tether cable
over a hook on the inside of the fuel door. This keeps the
gas cap suspended away from and protects the vehicle’s
surface.
374 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• Damage to the fuel system or emission control
system could result from using an improper fuel
tank filler tube cap (gas cap).
• A poorly fitting gas cap may cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” to turn on.
• To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top
off” the fuel tank after filling. When the fuel
nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank is full.
Tether Cable
NOTE: If the gas cap is lost or damaged, be sure the
replacement cap is for use with this vehicle.
WARNING!
• Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the
vehicle when the gas cap is removed or the tank is
being filled.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 375
WARNING! (Continued)
Loose Filler Cap Message
If the vehicles diagnostic system determines that the fuel
filler cap in loose, improperly installed, or damaged, a
“gASCAP” message will be displayed in the instrument
cluster. Tighten the gas cap until a “clicking” sound is
heard. This is an indication that the gas cap is properly
tightened. Press the trip odometer reset button to turn off
the message. If the problem persists, the message will
appear the next time the vehicle is started. This might
indicate a damaged cap. If the problem is detected twice
NOTE:
in a row, the system will turn on the MIL. Resolving the
• Tighten the gas cap until you hear a “clicking” sound. problem will turn the MIL off.
This is an indication that the gas cap is tightened
properly. The MIL in the instrument cluster may turn
on if the gas cap is not secured properly. Make sure
that the gas cap is tightened each time the vehicle is
refueled.
• Never add fuel when the engine is running. This is
in violation of most state and federal fire regulations and doing so may cause the MIL to turn on.
• A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into a
portable container that is inside of a vehicle. You
could be burned. Always place gas containers on
the ground while filling.
• When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank
is full.
5
376 STARTING AND OPERATING
VEHICLE LOADING
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
This includes driver, passengers, and cargo. The total
Your vehicle has a Vehicle Certification Label affixed to
load must be limited so that you do not exceed the
the rear of the driver’s door.
GVWR.
The label contains the following information:
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
• Name of manufacturer
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
• Month and year of manufacture
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or
• Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
rear GAWR.
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) front
Vehicle Certification Label
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) rear
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
• Type of Vehicle
• Month Day and Hour of Manufacture (MDH)
The bar code allows a computer scanner to read the VIN.
WARNING!
Because the front wheels steer the vehicle, it is
important that you do not exceed the maximum front
or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition can
result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
STARTING AND OPERATING 377
Overloading
Loading
The load carrying components (axle, springs, tires,
wheels, etc.) of your vehicle will provide satisfactory
service as long as you do not exceed the GVWR and the
front and rear GAWR.
To load your vehicle properly, first figure out its empty
weight, axle-by-axle and side-by-side. Store heavier items
down low and be sure you distribute their weight as
evenly as possible. Stow all loose items securely before
driving. If weighing the loaded vehicle shows that you
have exceeded either GAWR, but the total load is within
the specified GVWR, you must redistribute the weight.
Improper weight distribution can have an adverse effect
on the way your vehicle steers and handles and the way
the brakes operate.
The best way to figure out the total weight of your
vehicle is to weigh it when it is fully loaded and ready for
operation. Weigh it on a commercial scale to ensure that
it is not over the GVWR.
Figure out the weight on the front and rear of the vehicle
separately. It is important that you distribute the load
TRAILER TOWING
evenly over the front and rear axles.
Overloading can cause potential safety hazards and
shorten useful service life. Heavier axles or suspension
components do not necessarily increase the vehicle’s
GVWR.
In this section you will find safety tips and information
on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do
with your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully
review this information to tow your load as efficiently
and safely as possible.
5
378 STARTING AND OPERATING
To maintain warranty coverage, follow the requirements ready for operation⬙ condition. The recommended way to
and recommendations in this manual concerning ve- measure GTW is to put your fully loaded trailer on a
vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be
hicles used for trailer towing.
supported by the scale.
Common Towing Definitions
The following trailer towing related definitions will assist Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)
you in understanding the following information:
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
This includes driver, passengers, cargo and tongue
weight. The total load must be limited so that you do not
exceed the GVWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle
Certification Label” in “Starting and Operating” for
further information.
The GCWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicle
and trailer when weighed in combination.
NOTE: The GCWR rating includes a 150 lbs (68 kg)
allowance for the presence of a driver.
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)
rear GAWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle CertificaThe GTW is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all tion Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further
cargo, consumables and equipment (permanent or tem- information.
porary) loaded in or on the trailer in its ⬙loaded and
STARTING AND OPERATING 379
WARNING!
It is important that you do not exceed the maximum
front or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition
can result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
Frontal Area
The frontal area is the maximum height multiplied by the
maximum width of the front of a trailer.
Weight-Carrying Hitch
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue
weight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch ball or
Tongue Weight (TW)
some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds
The tongue weight is the downward force exerted on the of hitches are the most popular on the market today and
hitch ball by the trailer. In most cases it should not be less they are commonly used to tow small- and mediumthan 10% or more than 15% of the trailer load. You must sized trailers.
consider this as part of the load on your vehicle.
5
380 STARTING AND OPERATING
Trailer Hitch Classification
The following chart provides the industry standard for
the maximum trailer weight a given trailer hitch class can
tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the
correct trailer hitch for your intended towing condition.
Trailer Hitch Classification Definitions
Class
Max. Trailer Hitch Industry Standards
I - Light Duty
2,000 lbs (907 kg)
II - Medium Duty
3,500 lbs (1 587 kg)
III - Heavy Duty
5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)
IV - Extra Heavy
10,000 lbs (4 540 kg)
Class
Class
Class
Class
Duty
Refer to the “Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum
Trailer Weight Ratings)” chart for the Maximum
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) towable for your given
drivetrain.
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed
on your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 381
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)
The following chart provides the maximum trailer
weight ratings towable for your given drivetrain.
Engine/Transmission
2.4L/Auto
3.6L/Auto
Max. Frontal Area
Max. Gross Trailer Wt.
(GTW)
1,000 lbs (450 kg)
11 sq.ft. (1.0 sq.m) (See
Note 2)
22 sq.ft. (2.0 sq.m)
1,000 lbs (450 kg)
Refer to local laws for maximum trailer towing speeds.
Note 1: The trailer tongue weight must be considered as
part of the combined weight of occupants and cargo,
and it should never exceed the weight referenced on the
Tire and Loading Information placard. Refer to “Tire
Safety Information” in “Starting and Operating” for
further information.
Max. Trailer Tongue Wt.
(See Note 1)
100 lbs (45 kg)
100 lbs (45 kg)
all four-cylinder engines with automatic transmission.
Please see your authorized dealer for additional information.
Trailer And Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight in
the front of the trailer. This places 10% to 15% of the
Note 2: Enclosed trailers or open utility trailers with Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of your
front shields/guards are not recommended for use with
5
382 STARTING AND OPERATING
vehicle. Loads balanced over the wheels or heavier in the
rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side
which will cause loss of control of the vehicle and trailer.
Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of
many trailer collisions.
Consider the following items when computing the
weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
• The tongue weight of the trailer.
• The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment
put in or on your vehicle.
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on
• The weight of the driver and all passengers.
your bumper or trailer hitch.
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the
trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additional
factory-installed options or dealer-installed options must
be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle.
Refer to the “Tire and Loading Information” placard for
the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo
for your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 383
Towing Requirements
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drivetrain components the following guidelines are recommended:
CAUTION!
• Do not tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles
(805 km) the new vehicle is driven. The engine, axle
or other parts could be damaged.
• Then, during the first 500 miles (805 km) that a
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at
the heavier loads.
WARNING!
Improper towing can lead to a collision. Follow these
guidelines to make your trailer towing as safe as
possible:
• Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer
and it will not shift during travel. When trailering
cargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shifts
can occur that may be difficult for the driver to
control. You could lose control of your vehicle and
have a collision.
• When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not
overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can
cause a loss of control, poor performance, or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transmission, steering,
suspension, chassis structure, or tires.
(Continued)
5
384 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Safety chains must always be used between your
vehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains to
the frame or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch.
Cross the chains under the trailer tongue and allow
enough slack for turning corners.
• Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a
grade. When parking, apply the parking brake on
the tow vehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic
transmission in PARK. Always, block or ⴖchockⴖ
the trailer wheels.
• GCWR must not be exceeded.
• Total weight must be distributed between the tow
vehicle and the trailer such that the following four
ratings are not exceeded:
(Continued)
1. Max loading as defined on the “Tire and Loading
Information” placard.
2. GTW
3. GAWR
4. Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized.
STARTING AND OPERATING 385
Towing Requirements – Tires
• Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact
spare tire.
replacement procedures. Replacing tires with a higher
load carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle’s
GVWR and GAWR limits.
Towing Requirements – Trailer Brakes
• Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe
and satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Refer to • Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system or
vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the trailer.
“Tires – General Information” in “Starting and OperThis could cause inadequate braking and possible
ating” for proper tire inflation procedures.
personal injury.
• Check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation pres• An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is
sures before trailer usage.
required when towing a trailer with electronically
• Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage
actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with
before towing a trailer. Refer to “Tires – General
a hydraulic surge actuated brake system, an electronic
Information” in “Starting and Operating” for the
brake controller is not required.
proper inspection procedure.
• Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over
• When replacing tires, refer to “Tires – General Infor1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in excess of
mation” in “Starting and Operating” for the proper tire
2,000 lbs (907 kg).
5
386 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
WARNING! (Continued)
If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg)
loaded, it should have its own brakes and they
should be of adequate capacity. Failure to do this
could lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higher
brake pedal effort, and longer stopping distances.
• Towing any trailer will increase your stopping
distance. When towing you should allow for additional space between your vehicle and the vehicle
in front of you. Failure to do so could result in a
collision.
Towing Requirements – Trailer Lights And Wiring
WARNING!
• Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle’s
hydraulic brake lines. It can overload your brake
system and cause it to fail. You might not have
brakes when you need them and could have a
collision.
(Continued)
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size,
stop lights and turn signals on the trailer are required for
motoring safety.
Towing Tips
Before setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping,
and backing up the trailer in an area located away from
heavy traffic.
STARTING AND OPERATING 387
Automatic Transmission
The DRIVE range can be selected when towing. However, if frequent shifting occurs while in this range, select
the ⬙3⬙ range (with four-speed transmission) or select a
lower gear using the AutoStick威 shift control (with
six-speed transmission).
NOTE: Check the transmission fluid level (four-speed
transmission only) before towing. The six-speed transmission does not require a fluid level check before
towing. If, however, you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, see your authorized dealer immediately for assistance.
AutoStick威 – If Equipped
NOTE: Using a lower gear while operating the vehicle
under heavy loading conditions, will improve perfor- – When using the AutoStick威 shift control, select the
highest gear that allows for adequate performance and
mance and extend transmission life by reducing excesavoids frequent downshifts. For example, choose “4” if
sive shifting and heat build-up. This action will also
the desired speed can be maintained. Choose “3” or
provide better engine braking.
“2” if needed to maintain the desired speed.
If you REGULARLY TOW a trailer for more than 45
minutes of continuous operation, then change the auto- – Extended driving at high RPM should be avoided to
prevent excess heat generation. A reduction in vehicle
matic transmission fluid and filter as specified for “pospeed may be required to avoid extended driving at
lice, taxi, fleet, or frequent trailer towing.” Refer to the
high RPM. Return to a higher gear or vehicle speed
“Maintenance Schedule” for the proper maintenance
when grade and road conditions allow.
intervals.
5
388 STARTING AND OPERATING
Electronic Speed Control – If Equipped
Cooling System
• Do not use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
To reduce potential for engine and transmission overheating, take the following actions:
• When using the speed control, if you experience speed
drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), disengage until City Driving
you can get back to cruising speed.
When stopped for short periods of time, shift the trans• Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to mission into NEUTRAL and increase engine idle speed.
maximize fuel efficiency.
Highway Driving
Reduce speed.
Air Conditioning
Turn off temporarily.
STARTING AND OPERATING 389
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Dolly Tow
On Trailer
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Front
Rear
ALL
All Models
NOT ALLOWED
OK
NOT ALLOWED
OK
3. Firmly apply the parking brake. Place the transmission in PARK.
Recreational towing is allowed ONLY if the front wheels
are OFF the ground. This may be accomplished using a 4. Properly secure the front wheels to the dolly, following
tow dolly or vehicle trailer. If using a tow dolly, follow
the dolly manufacturer’s instructions.
this procedure:
5. Release the parking brake.
1. Properly secure the dolly to the tow vehicle, following
the dolly manufacturer’s instructions.
Recreational Towing – All Models
2. Drive the front wheels onto the tow dolly.
5
390 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• DO NOT flat tow this vehicle. Damage to the
drivetrain will result.
• Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage.
Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS . . . . . . . . . . .392
▫ Road Tire Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
䡵 IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS . . . . . . . . . . . .392 䡵 JUMP-STARTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
▫ Engine Oil Overheating (2.4L Engine Only) — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
䡵 JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Spare Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Preparations For Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
▫ Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .407
䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE. . . . . . . . . . . . . .409
䡵 SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
䡵 TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . .412
▫ Without The Ignition Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414
6
392 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the In any of the following situations, you can reduce the
instrument panel, below the radio.
potential for overheating by taking the appropriate action.
Press the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning
flasher. When the switch is activated, all direc- • On the highways — Slow down.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming • In city traffic — While stopped, put transaxle in
traffic of an emergency. Press the switch a second time to
NEUTRAL, but do not increase engine idle speed.
turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
This is an emergency warning system and it should not
be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when your
vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for
other motorists.
When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance, the
Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate even
though the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
NOTE: With extended use the Hazard Warning flashers
may wear down your battery.
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage
your vehicle. If temperature gauge reads “H”, pull
over and stop the vehicle with the engine at idle,
when safe. Turn the air conditioner off and wait until
the pointer drops back into the normal range. After
appropriate action has been taken, if the pointer
remains on the “H”, turn the engine off immediately,
and call for service.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 393
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down
an impending overheat condition:
• If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C
system adds heat to the engine cooling system and
turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If you
see or hear steam coming from under the hood, do not
open the hood until the radiator has had time to cool.
Never try to open a cooling system pressure cap when
the radiator or coolant bottle is hot.
• You can also turn the temperature control to maximum
heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control
to high. This allows the heater core to act as a
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat Engine Oil Overheating (2.4L Engine Only) — If
Equipped
from the engine cooling system.
During sustained high-speed driving or trailer tow up
long grades on a hot day, the engine oil temperature may
become too hot. If this happens, the “HOTOIL” message
flashes in the odometer and the vehicle speed will be
reduced to 53 mph (85 km/h) until the engine oil
temperature is reduced.
6
394 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
NOTE: The vehicle speed is reduced to a maximum of
53 mph (85 km/h). You may of course, reduce your
vehicle speed further if needed.
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING
WARNING!
• Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
• Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous. The
vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you. You
could be crushed. Never put any part of your body
under a vehicle that is on a jack. If you need to get
under a raised vehicle, take it to a service center
where it can be raised on a lift.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never start or run the engine while the vehicle is
on a jack.
• The jack is designed to be used as a tool for
changing tires only. The jack should not be used to
lift the vehicle for service purposes. The vehicle
should be jacked on a firm level surface only.
Avoid ice or slippery areas.
Jack Location
The jack and jack-handle are stowed under the load floor
in the trunk.
Spare Tire Stowage
The compact spare tire is stowed under the rear load floor
in the trunk.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 395
Spare Tire Removal
Lift up the load floor cover and remove the hold down.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic, pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
2. Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
3. Set the parking brake.
4. Place the shift lever into PARK (automatic transmission) or REVERSE (manual transmission).
5. Turn OFF the ignition.
Spare Tire And Jack Storage
Preparations For Jacking
1. Park the vehicle on a firm, level surface. Avoid ice or
slippery areas.
6
396 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
6. Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally
opposite the jacking position. For
example, if changing the right front
tire, block the left rear wheel.
NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle
while the vehicle is being jacked.
Jacking Instructions
WARNING!
Carefully follow these tire changing warnings to
help prevent personal injury or damage to your
vehicle:
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Always park on a firm, level surface as far from the
edge of the roadway as possible before raising the
vehicle.
• Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
• Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to
be raised.
• Set the parking brake firmly and set an automatic
transmission in PARK; a manual transmission in
REVERSE.
• Never start or run the engine with the vehicle on a
jack.
• Do not let anyone sit in the vehicle when it is on a
jack.
• Do not get under the vehicle when it is on a jack. If
you need to get under a raised vehicle, take it to a
service center where it can be raised on a lift.
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 397
WARNING! (Continued)
• Only use the jack in the positions indicated and for
lifting this vehicle during a tire change.
• If working on or near a roadway, be extremely
careful of motor traffic.
• To assure that spare tires, flat or inflated, are
securely stowed, spares must be stowed with the
valve stem facing the ground.
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in the Jacking
Instructions for this vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to the Compact Spare Tire section of Tires-General Information--for information about the spare
tire, its use, and operation.
1. Remove the scissors jack and lug wrench from the
spare wheel as an assembly. Turn the jack screw to the
left to loosen the lug wrench, and remove the wrench
from the jack assembly.
Jack Warning Label
NOTE: The jack handle attaches to the side of the jack
with two attachment points. When the jack is partially
expanded, the tension between the two attachment
points holds the jack handle in place.
6
398 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in Step 3.
Removing Jack Handle From Jack
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the wheel nuts by turning
them to the left one turn while the wheel is still on the
ground.
Jacking Locations
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 399
3. There is a front and rear jacking location on each side
of the vehicle.
Rear Jacking Location
Front Jacking Location
4. Turn the jack screw to the left until the jack can be
placed under the jacking location. Once the jack is
positioned, turn the jack screw to the right until the
jack head is properly engaged with the lift area closest
to the wheel to be changed. Do not raise the vehicle
until you are sure the jack is securely engaged.
6
400 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can make
the vehicle less stable. It could slip off the jack and
hurt someone near it. Raise the vehicle only enough
to remove the tire.
5. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the right,
using the swivel wrench. Raise the vehicle only until
the tire just clears the surface and enough clearance is
obtained to install the spare tire. Minimum tire lift
provides maximum stability.
6. Remove the wheel nuts, and pull the wheel and wheel
covers (where applicable) off the hub. Install the spare
wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped end of the
nuts toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the nuts.
CAUTION!
Be sure to mount the spare tire with the valve stem
facing outward. The vehicle could be damaged if the
spare tire is mounted incorrectly.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 401
WARNING!
• To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning
may result in personal injury.
• To avoid possible personal injury, handle the
wheel covers with care to avoid contact with any
sharp edges.
7. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the left.
Mounting Spare Tire
8. Finish tightening the nuts. Push down on the wrench
while at the end of the handle for increased leverage.
Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until each nut has
been tightened twice. The correct wheel nut torque is
100 ft lbs (135 N·m). If you doubt that you have
tightened the nuts correctly, have them checked with a
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or at a
service station.
6
402 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
9. Remove the wheel blocks and lower the jack until it is Road Tire Installation
free. Release the emergency brake before driving the
Vehicles Equipped With Wheel Covers
vehicle. Reassemble the lug wrench to the jack assembly and stow it in the spare tire area. Secure the 1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
assembly using the means provided.
2. To ease the installation process for steel wheels with
wheel covers, install two lug nuts on the mounting
WARNING!
studs which are on each side of the valve stem. Install
the lug nuts with the cone shaped end of the nut
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or
toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the lug nuts.
hard stop could endanger the occupants of the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in
WARNING!
the places provided.
10. Place the deflated (flat) tire in the cargo area and have
the tire repaired or replaced as soon as possible.
11. Check the tire pressure as soon as possible. Correct
the tire pressure as required.
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 403
3. Align the valve notch in the wheel cover with the
valve stem on the wheel. Install the cover by hand,
snapping the cover over the two lug nuts. Do not use
a hammer or excessive force to install the cover.
4. Install the remaining lug nuts with the cone shaped
end of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the
lug nuts.
WARNING!
Tire And Wheel Cover Or Center Cap
1 — Valve Stem
2 — Valve Notch
3 — Wheel Lug Nut
4 — Wheel Cover
5 — Mounting Stud
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
5. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
6
404 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
6. Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the
WARNING!
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
each nut has been tightened twice. The correct tight- do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
ness of each lug nut is 100 ft/lbs (135 N·m). If in doubt has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
about the correct tightness, have them checked with a result in personal injury.
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or service
3. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
station.
handle counterclockwise.
7. After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut torque with a
torque wrench to ensure that all lug nuts are properly 4. Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
seated against the wheel.
leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until
Vehicles Without Wheel Covers
each nut has been tightened twice. The correct tightness of each lug nut is 100 ft/lbs (135 N·m). If in doubt
1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
about the correct tightness, have them checked with a
2. Install the remaining lug nuts with the cone shaped
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or service
end of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the
station.
lug nuts.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 405
5. After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut torque with a
torque wrench to ensure that all lug nuts are properly
seated against the wheel.
JUMP-STARTING
If your vehicle has a discharged battery it can be jumpstarted using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
CAUTION!
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system may occur.
WARNING!
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack
follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and Preparations For Jump-Start
precautions.
The battery in your vehicle is located between the left
front headlight assembly and the left front wheel splash
shield. To allow jump-starting there are remote battery
posts located on the left side of the engine compartment.
6
406 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Remote Battery Posts
1 — Remote Positive (+) Post (covered with protective cap)
2 — Remote Negative (-) Post
• Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be injured by
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as watch bands or
bracelets that might make an inadvertent electrical
contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
1. Set the parking brake, shift the automatic transmission
into PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 407
3. Remove the protective cover over the remote positive 4. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
(+) battery post. To remove the cover, press the locking
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
tab and pull upward on the cover.
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Locking Tab
Failure to follow this procedure could result in personal injury or property damage due to battery explosion.
6
408 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
Do not connect the cable to the negative post (-) of the
discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark
could cause the battery to explode and could result in
personal injury.
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
remote positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
start the engine in the vehicle with the discharged
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
battery.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables in
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
the reverse sequence:
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper 6. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
cable to the remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with
remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with the disthe discharged battery.
charged battery.
7. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 409
8. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
CAUTION! (Continued)
battery will discharge sufficiently to degrade battery
9. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable life and/or prevent the engine from starting.
from the remote positive (+) post of the discharged
vehicle.
FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
10. Reinstall the protective cover over the remote posi- If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand, or snow, it
tive (+) battery post of the discharged vehicle.
can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle, steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
you should have the battery and charging system in- front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
and REVERSE, while gently pressing the accelerator. Use
spected at your authorized dealer.
the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure to maintain the rocking motion, without spinning the wheels, or
CAUTION!
racing the engine.
Accessories that can be plugged into the vehicle
power outlets draw power from the vehicle’s battery,
even when not in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.).
Eventually, if plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s
(Continued)
6
410 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels may lead to
transmission overheating and failure. Allow the engine to idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL for at
least one minute after every five rocking-motion
cycles. This will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of transmission failure during prolonged
efforts to free a stuck vehicle.
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE and REVERSE, do not spin the
wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain
damage may result.
• Revving the engine or spinning the wheels too fast
may lead to transmission overheating and failure.
It can also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels
above 30 mph (48 km/h) while in gear (no transmission shifting occurring).
NOTE: Press the ⬙ESC Off⬙ switch, to place the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system in ⬙Partial Off⬙ mode,
before rocking the vehicle. Refer to “Electronic Brake
Control” in “Starting And Operating” for further information. Once the vehicle has been freed, press the ⬙ESC
Off⬙ switch again to restore ⬙ESC On⬙ mode.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 411
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE
3. Remove the rubber cupholder liner. Squeeze one side
of the liner’s center to expose its edge and facilitate
removal.
4. Turn the ignition to the ACC or ON/RUN position,
but do not start the engine.
5. Press and maintain firm pressure on the brake pedal.
6. Insert a screwdriver or similar tool into the access hole
(at the front of the cupholder) and push and hold the
override release lever forward.
7. Move the shift lever to the NEUTRAL position.
If a malfunction occurs and the shift lever cannot be 8. The vehicle may then be started in NEUTRAL.
moved out of the PARK position, you can use the
9. Reinstall the cupholder liner.
following procedure to temporarily move the shift lever:
1. Turn the engine OFF.
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
6
412 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled vehicle using a towing service.
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Wheel Lift Or Dolly Tow
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Rear
Flatbed
Front
ALL
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to prevent
damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars and other
equipment designed for this purpose, following equipment manufacturer’s instructions. Use of safety chains is
mandatory. Attach a tow bar or other towing device to
main structural members of the vehicle, not to bumpers
or associated brackets. State and local laws regarding
vehicles under tow must be observed.
All Models
If transmission is operable:
• Transmission in NEUTRAL
• 25 mph (40 km/h) max speed
• 15 mi (24 km) max distance
OK
BEST METHOD
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN
position, not the ACC position.
If your vehicle’s battery is discharged, see ⬙Shift Lever
Override⬙ in ⬙What To Do In Emergencies⬙ for instructions on shifting the automatic transmission out of PARK
for towing.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 413
CAUTION!
• Do not use sling type equipment when towing.
Damage to the fascia will occur.
• When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck, do not
attach to front or rear suspension components.
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper
towing.
• Do not push or tow this vehicle with another
vehicle as damage to the bumper fascia and transmission may result.
The manufacturer recommends towing your vehicle with
all four wheels OFF the ground using a flatbed.
If flatbed equipment is not available, and the transmission is operable, the vehicle may be flat towed (with all
four wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:
• The transmission must be in NEUTRAL.
• The towing distance must not exceed 15 mi (24 km).
• The towing speed must not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
If the transmission is not operable, or the vehicle must
be towed faster than 25 mph (40 km/h) or farther than 15
mi (24 km), it must be towed with the front wheels OFF
the ground (using a flatbed truck, towing dolly, or
wheel lift equipment with the front wheels raised).
CAUTION!
Towing faster than 25 mph (40 km/h) or farther than
15 mi (24 km) with front wheels on the ground can
cause severe transmission damage. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
6
414 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Without The Ignition Key
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed
with the ignition in the LOCK/OFF position. Flatbed
towing is the preferred towing method. However, if a
flatbed towing vehicle is not available, wheel lift towing
equipment may be used. Rear towing (with the front
wheels on the ground) is not allowed, as transmission
damage will occur. If rear towing is the only alternative,
the front wheels must be placed on a towing dolly. Proper
towing equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the
vehicle.
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 2.4L . . . . . . . . . .417
▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L . . . . . . . . . .418
▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
䡵 ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II . .419
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
▫ Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . .419
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
䡵 EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . .420
▫ A/C Air Filter – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .422
▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
▫ Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
▫ Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
7
416 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .441
▫ Headlamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .443
▫ Front Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .463
▫ Appearance Care And Protection
From Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
▫ Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .463
▫ Cleaning Center Console Cupholders. . . . . . . .453
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
▫ Integrated Power Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
▫ Backup Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
▫ License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .466
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .459
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE
PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .467
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .460
▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .467
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 417
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 2.4L
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
— Engine Coolant Reservoir
— Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
— Automatic Transmission Dipstick
— Brake Fluid Reservoir
— Integrated Power Module (Fuses)
— Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
7 — Air Cleaner Filter
8 — Engine Oil Fill
9 — Coolant Pressure Cap
10 — Engine Oil Dipstick
11 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
418 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Engine Coolant Reservoir
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Integrated Power Module (Fuses)
5
6
7
8
— Air Cleaner Filter
— Engine Oil Dipstick
— Engine Oil Fill
— Washer Fluid Reservoir
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 419
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors
the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic
transmission control systems. When these systems are
operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light” (MIL). It
will also store diagnostic codes and other information to
assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
soon as possible.
CAUTION!
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
further damage to the emission control system. It
could also affect fuel economy and drivability. The
vehicle must be serviced before any emissions tests
can be performed.
• If the MIL is flashing while the engine is running,
severe catalytic converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is required.
Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message
After fuel is added, the vehicle diagnostic system can
determine if the fuel filler cap is possibly loose or
improperly installed. A “GASCAP” message will be
displayed in the instrument cluster. Tighten the gas cap
until a ⬙clicking⬙ sound is heard. This is an indication that
the gas cap is properly tightened. Press the trip odometer
“Reset” button to turn off the message. If the problem
7
420 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
persists, the message will appear the next time the
vehicle is started. This might indicate a damaged cap. If
the problem is detected twice in a row, the system will
turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” Resolving the problem will turn the MIL light off.
Normally, the OBD II system will be ready. The OBD II
system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently
serviced, recently had a dead battery or a battery replacement. If the OBD II system should be determined not
ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.
Your vehicle has a simple ignition key-actuated test,
which you can use prior to going to the test station. To
check if your vehicle’s OBD II system is ready, you must
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass do the following:
an inspection of your vehicle’s emissions control system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, but do not
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.
crank or start the engine.
For states that require an Inspection and Maintenance (I/M), this check verifies the “Malfunction 2. If you crank or start the engine, you will have to start
this test over.
Indicator Light (MIL)” is functioning and is not
on when the engine is running, and that the OBD II 3. As soon as you turn the ignition switch to the ON
system is ready for testing.
position, you will see the MIL symbol come on as part
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS
of a normal bulb check.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 421
4. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will Regardless of whether your vehicle’s OBD II system is
happen:
ready or not, if the MIL is illuminated during normal
vehicle operation you should have your vehicle serviced
• The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then
before going to the I/M station. The I/M station can fail
return to being fully illuminated until you turn OFF
your vehicle because the MIL is on with the engine
the ignition or start the engine. This means that your
running.
vehicle’s OBD II system is not ready and you should
not proceed to the I/M station.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
• The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully
illuminated until you turn OFF the ignition or start the
engine. This means that your vehicle’s OBD II system
is ready and you can proceed to the I/M station.
Use of genuine MOPAR威 parts for normal/scheduled
maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures
caused by the use of non-MOPAR威 parts for maintenance
If your OBD II system is not ready, you should see your and repairs will not be covered by the manufacturer’s
authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was warranty.
recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement, DEALER SERVICE
you may need to do nothing more than drive your
vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD II Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personsystem to update. A recheck with the above test routine nel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
may then indicate that the system is now ready.
7
422 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
available which include detailed service information for MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
attempting any procedure yourself.
services determined by the engineers who designed your
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control vehicle.
systems may void your warranty and could result in civil Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
penalties being assessed against you.
maintenance schedule, there are other components which
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Only do service work for which you
have the knowledge and the proper equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 423
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, power steering or air conditioning.
Such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty. If a flush is needed because of
component malfunction, use only the specified
fluid for the flushing procedure.
Engine Oil
Checking Oil Level
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop. The best time to
check the engine oil level is about five minutes after a
fully warmed engine is shut off. Do not check oil level
before starting the engine after it has sat overnight.
Checking engine oil level when the engine is cold will
give you an incorrect reading.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground and
only when the engine is hot, will improve the accuracy of
the oil level readings. Maintain the oil level between the
range markings on the dipstick. Either the range markings consist of a crosshatch zone marked SAFE or a
crosshatch zone marked with MIN at the low end of the
range and MAX at the high end of the range. Adding one
quart of oil when the reading is at the low end of the
range marking will raise the oil level to the high end of
the range marking.
7
424 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not overfill the engine. Overfilling the engine
will cause oil aeration, which can lead to loss of oil
pressure and an increase in oil temperature. This
could damage your engine. Also, be sure the oil fill
cap is replaced and tightened after adding oil.
Engine Oil Selection
For best performance and maximum protection under all
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395.
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil
Identification Symbol
Change Engine Oil
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is
time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for further information.
NOTE:Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months,
whichever occurs first.
This symbol means that the oil has
been certified by the American
Petroleum Institute (API). The
manufacturer only recommends
API Certified engine oils.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 425
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your engine oil as the
chemicals can damage your engine. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Engine Oil Viscosity – 3.6L Engine
SAE 5W-20 engine oil is recommended for all operating
temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature
starting and vehicle fuel economy.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on
SAE 5W-20 engine oil is recommended for all operating engine oil filler cap location, refer to the “Engine Comtemperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature partment” illustration in this section.
starting and vehicle fuel economy.
Synthetic Engine Oils
Engine Oil Viscosity – 2.4L Engine
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on
the engine oil filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information.
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recommended oil quality requirements are met, and the recommended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes
are followed.
Materials Added To Engine Oil
Lubricants that do not have both, the engine oil certifiThe manufacturer strongly recommends against the addication mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade number tion of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to the
should not be used.
7
426 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and its quality filters should be used to assure most efficient
performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. service. MOPAR威 engine oil filters are a high quality oil
filter and are recommended.
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil Filters
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and oil Engine Air Cleaner Filter
filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters, indiscrimi- Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
nately discarded, can present a problem to the environment. maintenance intervals.
Contact your authorized dealer, service station or governmental agency for advice on how and where used oil and oil
WARNING!
filters can be safely discarded in your area.
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) can
Engine Oil Filter
provide a measure of protection in the case of engine
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter backfire. Do not remove the air induction system (air
cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless such removal is necessary for
at every engine oil change.
repair or maintenance. Make sure that no one is near
Engine Oil Filter Selection
the engine compartment before starting the vehicle
This manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type oil with the air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.)
filter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The quality removed. Failure to do so can result in serious personal
of replacement filters varies considerably. Only high injury.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 427
Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection
The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters
varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be
used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR威 engine air
cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recommended.
Maintenance-Free Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery.
You will never have to add water, nor is periodic maintenance required.
NOTE: The battery is stored in a compartment behind
the left front fender and is accessible without removing
the tire and wheel. Remote battery terminals are located
in the engine compartment for jump-starting. Refer to
“Jump-Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
To access the battery, turn the steering wheel fully to the
right and remove the inner fender shield.
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
7
428 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to
the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive
(+) and negative (-) and are identified on the
battery case. Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
• If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not
use a “fast charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner
should be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer
at the start of each warm season. This service should
include cleaning of the condenser fins and a performance
test. Drive belt tension should also be checked at this
time.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 429
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants
approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, injuring you. Other
unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause the
system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Refer to
Warranty Information Book, located on the DVD,
for further warranty information.
• The air conditioning system contains refrigerant
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal
injury or damage to the system, adding refrigerant
or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected
should be done by an experienced technician.
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling
R-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental
Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. However, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning
service be performed by authorized dealer or other
service facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system
sealers, stop leak products, seal conditioners, compressor
oil, and refrigerants.
A/C Air Filter – If Equipped
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
WARNING!
Do not remove the A/C air filter while the blower is
operating or personal injury may result.
7
430 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
The A/C Air Filter is located in the fresh air inlet behind 5. Disengage the two retaining tabs that secure the filter
the glove box. Perform the following procedure to recover to the HVAC housing and remove the cover.
place the filter:
1. Open the glove box and remove all contents.
2. Push in on the sides of the glove box and lower the
door.
3. Disconnect the glove box door dampener from the slot
on the side of the box. This is done by grasping the
dampener connector (on the outside of the box) and
the end of the connector pin (on the inside of the box)
with your thumb and forefinger and pulling outward
while lightly lifting upward on the door with your
other hand. Once disconnected, the dampener will
A/C Air Filter Replacement
retract underneath the instrument panel if you release
6. Remove the A/C Air Filter by pulling it straight out of
it.
the housing.
4. Pivot the glove box downward.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 431
7. Install the A/C Air Filter with the arrow on the filter
pointing toward the floor. When installing the filter
cover, make sure the retaining tabs fully engage the
cover.
CAUTION!
The A/C air filter is identified with an arrow to
indicate airflow direction through the filter. Failure
to install the filter properly will result in the need to
replace it more often.
MOPAR威 Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to the
application of any lubricant, the parts concerned should
be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after lubricating
excess oil and grease should be removed. Particular
attention should also be given to hood latching components to ensure proper function. When performing other
underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism
and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
8. Reinstall the glove box door dampener and glove box. amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR威
Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
Body Lubrication
Windshield Wiper Blades
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate, Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
tailgate, sliding doors and hood hinges, should be lubri- windshield periodically with a sponge or soft cloth and a
cated periodically with a lithium based grease, such as mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove accumulations of salt or road film.
7
432 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt
from a dry windshield.
reservoir with windshield washer solvent (not radiator
antifreeze) and operate the system for a few seconds to
flush out the residual water.
When refilling the washer fluid reservoir, apply some
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from washer fluid to a cloth or towel and wipe the wiper
the windshield. Keep the blade rubber out of contact with blades clean. This will help blade performance.
petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depend- in cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets or
ing on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor exceeds the temperature range of your climate. This
performance of blades may be present with chattering, rating information can be found on most washer fluid
marks, water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions containers.
are present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necesWARNING!
sary.
Adding Washer Fluid
The windshield washer and the rear window washer
share the same fluid reservoir. The fluid reservoir is
located in the engine compartment. Be sure to check the
fluid level in the reservoir at regular intervals. Fill the
Commercially available windshield washer solvents
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 433
Exhaust System
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system;
or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle;
or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;
have an authorized technician inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep
into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the
exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
WARNING!
• Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and
odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious
and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing
CO, refer to “Safety Tips/Exhaust Gas” in “Things
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further
information.
• A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park
over materials that can burn. Such materials might
be grass or leaves coming into contact with your
exhaust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in areas where your exhaust system can contact anything that can burn.
7
434 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the
effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control
device and may seriously reduce engine performance and cause serious damage to the engine.
• Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition.
In the event of engine malfunction, particularly
involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of
performance, have your vehicle serviced promptly.
Continued operation of your vehicle with a severe
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,
resulting in possible damage to the converter and
vehicle.
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic converter will not require maintenance. However, it is important to keep the engine properly tuned to assure
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst
damage.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed
against you.
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.
Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained immediately.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 435
To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter dam- Cooling System
age:
• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition,
when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
motion.
• Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the
vehicle.
• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires
disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic
testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough
idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
WARNING!
• When working near the radiator cooling fan,
disconnect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position. The fan is temperature controlled and can start at anytime the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
• You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had
time to cool. Never try to open a cooling system
pressure cap when the radiator is hot.
7
436 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Coolant Checks
Cooling System – Drain, Flush, And Refill
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where
applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or
rusty in appearance, the system should be drained,
flushed, and refilled with fresh engine coolant (antifreeze). Check the front of the A/C condenser for any
accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the
face of the condenser.
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains a
considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with a
reliable cooling system cleaner. Follow with a thorough
rinsing to remove all deposits and chemicals. Properly
dispose of the old engine coolant (antifreeze) solution.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
Selection Of Coolant
Check the coolant recovery bottle tubing for brittle rub- Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
ber, cracking, tears, cuts, and tightness of the connection “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
at the bottle and radiator. Inspect the entire system for
leaks.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 437
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, it should be replaced with
the specified engine coolant (antifreeze) as soon as
possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
(Continued)
Adding Coolant
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine
coolant (antifreeze) that allows extended maintenance
intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up
to ten years or 150,000 miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing this extended maintenance
7
438 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
period, it is important that you use the same engine Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to maincoolant (antifreeze) throughout the life of your vehicle. tain the proper level of protection against freezing according to the temperatures occurring in the area where
Please review these recommendations for using Organic
the vehicle is operated.
Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze).
NOTE: Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not
When adding engine coolant (antifreeze):
recommended and can result in cooling system damage.
• We recommend using MOPAR威 Antifreeze/Coolant
Drain, flush, and refill as soon as possible to avoid
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive
damage if coolant types are mixed in an emergency.
Technology).
Cooling System Pressure Cap
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant
and distilled water. Use higher concentrations (not to The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine
exceed 70%) if temperatures below −34° F (−37° C) are coolant (antifreeze), and to ensure that engine coolant
(antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant
anticipated.
recovery tank.
• Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionized water when mixing the water/engine coolant The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any
(antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces.
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
engine cooling system.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 439
WARNING!
• The warning words “DO NOT OPEN HOT” on the
cooling system pressure cap are a safety precaution.
Never add engine coolant (antifreeze) when the
engine is overheated. Do not loosen or remove the
cap to cool an overheated engine. Heat causes
pressure to build up in the cooling system. To
prevent scalding or injury, do not remove the
pressure cap while the system is hot or under
pressure.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or engine damage may result.
Disposal Of Used Engine Coolant
rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by animals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based
engine coolant in open containers or allow it to remain in
puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek
emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground
spills immediately.
Coolant Level
Four-Cylinder Engines – the coolant bottle provides a
quick visual method for determining that the engine
coolant (antifreeze) level is adequate. With the engine
idling and warm to normal operating temperature, the
level of the engine coolant (antifreeze) in the bottle
should be between the “ADD” and “FULL” lines, shown
on the bottle.
Six-Cylinder Engines – the level of the engine coolant
Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is (antifreeze) in the pressurized coolant bottle should be
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check between the “COLD” and “FULL” range on the bottle
with your local authorities to determine the disposal when the engine is cold.
7
440 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
The radiator normally remains completely full, so there is
no need to remove the radiator cap unless checking for
engine coolant (antifreeze) freeze point or replacing coolant. Advise your service attendant of this. As long as the
engine operating temperature is satisfactory, the coolant
bottle need only be checked once a month. When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to maintain
the proper level, it should be added to the coolant bottle.
Do not overfill.
Points To Remember
If an examination of your engine compartment shows no
evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be
safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.
• Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
• Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in
the coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (antifreeze) needs to be added, the contents of the coolant
expansion bottle must also be protected against
freezing.
• If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
required, the cooling system should be pressure tested
kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming
for leaks.
from the front of the engine compartment. This is normally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high • Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at
50% OAT engine coolant (antifreeze) (minimum) and
humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vapordistilled water for proper corrosion protection of your
ized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine
engine which contains aluminum components.
coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 441
• Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle overflow
hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
• Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is
equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the
condenser clean.
WARNING!
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and
possible brake damage. You would not have your full
braking capacity in an emergency.
• Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter
operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install
ONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs may
result in unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze) Master Cylinder – Brake Fluid Level Check
performance, poor gas mileage, and increased
Check the fluid level in the master cylinder immediately
emissions.
if the brake system warning light indicates system failure.
Brake System
In order to assure brake system performance, all brake Check the fluid level in the master cylinder when persystem components should be inspected periodically. forming underhood services.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
7
442 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Clean the top of the master cylinder area before removing
the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the fluid level up
to the requirements described on the brake fluid reservoir.
Overfilling of fluid is not recommended because it may
cause leaking in the system.
Fluid level can be expected to fall as the brake pads wear.
Brake fluid level should be checked when pads are
replaced. However, low fluid level may be caused by a
leak and a checkup may be needed.
Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 443
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
(Continued)
Automatic Transmission
Selection Of Lubricant
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to
ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use
only the manufacturer’s recommended transmission
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for fluid specifications. It is
important to maintain the transmission fluid at the
correct level using the recommended fluid.
7
444 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: No chemical flushes should be used in any Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is an engineered
transmission; only the approved lubricant should be product and its performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. Therefore, do not add any fluid addiused.
tives to the transmission. The only exception to this
policy is the use of special dyes for diagnosing fluid
CAUTION!
leaks. Avoid using transmission sealers as they may
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufac- adversely affect seals.
turer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter
CAUTION!
shudder, and will require more frequent fluid and
Do not use chemical flushes in your transmission as
filter changes. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and
the chemicals can damage your transmission compoGenuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for
nents. Such damage is not covered by the New
fluid specifications.
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Special Additives
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using
any special additives in the transmission.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 445
6. Remove the dipstick and determine if the fluid is hot
or cold. Hot fluid is approximately 180° F (82° C),
Use the following procedure to check the transmission
which is the normal operating temperature after the
fluid level properly:
vehicle is driven at least 15 miles (24 km). Hot fluid
1. Park the vehicle on level ground.
cannot be held comfortably between the fingertips.
Cold fluid is at a temperature of approximately 80° F
2. Run the engine at normal idle speed for at least 60
(27° C).
seconds, and leave the engine running for the rest of
this procedure.
7. Wipe the dipstick clean and reinsert it until seated.
Then, remove the dipstick and note the fluid level on
3. Fully apply the parking brake, and press the brake
both sides. The fluid level reading is only valid if there
pedal.
is a solid coating of oil on both sides of the dipstick.
4. Place the shift lever momentarily into each gear posiNote that the holes in the dipstick will be full of fluid
tion (allowing time for the transmission to fully enif the actual level is at or above the hole.
gage in each position), ending with the shift lever in
• If the fluid is hot, the fluid level should be in the
PARK.
crosshatched area marked “HOT” (between the upper two holes in the dipstick).
5. Wipe the area around the dipstick clean to prevent dirt
• If the fluid is cold, the fluid level should be between
from entering the transmission.
the lower two holes in the area marked “COLD.”
Fluid Level Check – Four-Speed Transmission
7
446 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
If the fluid level is low, add fluid through the dipstick
tube to bring it to the proper level. Do not overfill. After
adding any quantity of oil through the dipstick tube, wait
at least two minutes for the oil to fully drain into the
transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
8. Check for leaks. Release the parking brake.
To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmission
after checking or replenishing fluid, make sure that the
dipstick cap is properly reseated.
CAUTION!
• Using a transmission fluid other than the manufacturer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter shudder, and will require more frequent
fluid and filter changes. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your
Vehicle” for fluid specifications.
• Dirt and water in the transmission can cause serious damage. To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmission after checking or replenishing
fluid, make sure that the dipstick cap is re-seated
properly.
Fluid Level Check – Six-Speed Transmission
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not
require adjustment under normal operating conditions.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 447
Routine fluid level checks are not required, therefore the
transmission has no dipstick. Your authorized dealer can
check your transmission fluid level using a special service dipstick. If you notice fluid leakage or transmission
malfunction, visit your authorized dealer immediately to
have the transmission fluid level checked. Operating the
vehicle with an improper fluid level can cause severe
transmission damage.
passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on
trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and underbody protection.
The following maintenance recommendations will enable
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
resistance built into your vehicle.
maintenance intervals.
What Causes Corrosion?
In addition, change the fluid and filter if the transmission
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
is disassembled for any reason.
paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
The most common causes are:
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads • Stone and gravel impact.
Fluid And Filter Changes
7
448 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
Washing
CAUTION!
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274
kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint and
decals.
• Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your vehicle in the shade using MOPAR威 Car Wash, or a mild
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
clear water.
Special Care
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumu- • If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
lated on your vehicle, use MOPAR威 Super Kleen Bug
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
and Tar Remover to remove.
a month.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR威 • It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
open.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing that
may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 449
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint, Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and
considered the responsibility of the owner.
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
• To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
MOPAR威 Wheel Cleaner.
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of
the owner.
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well
packaged and sealed.
• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
• Use MOPAR威 Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to
match the color of your vehicle.
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR威 Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
7
450 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cleaning Headlights
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure – If
Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlights and fog Equipped
lights (if equipped) that are lighter and less susceptible to Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following manner:
stone breakage than glass headlights.
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore
with a clean, dry towel.
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR威 Total Clean, or a
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To
mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution folstain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
lowed by rinsing.
• For grease stains, apply MOPAR威 Multi-Purpose
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of
protectants on Stain Repel products.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 451
Interior Care
Cleaning Leather Upholstery
Instrument Panel Cover
MOPAR威 Total Clean or equivalent is specifically recomThe instrument panel cover has a low glare surface, mended for leather upholstery.
which minimizes reflections in the windshield. Do not Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
use protectants or other products, which may cause cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt can
undesirable reflections. Use soap and warm water to act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery and
should be removed promptly with a damp cloth. Stubborn
restore the low glare surface.
soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth and MOPAR威
Cleaning Interior Trim
Total Clean or equivalent. Care should be taken to avoid
Interior Trim should be cleaned starting with a damp soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please do
cloth, a damp cloth with MOPAR威 Total Clean or equiva- not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents,
lent, then MOPAR威 Spot & Stain Remover or equivalent or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather upholif absolutely necessary. Do not use harsh cleaners or stery. Application of a leather conditioner is not required to
Armor All威. Use MOPAR威 Total Clean or equivalent to maintain the original condition.
clean vinyl upholstery
7
452 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
Glass Surfaces
When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the
towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
directly on the mirror.
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis
with MOPAR威 Glass Cleaner, or any commercial 1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be
household-type glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type
used, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive
cleaner. Use caution when cleaning the inside rear wincleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp
dow equipped with electric defrosters or the right rear
rag.
quarter window equipped with the radio antenna. Do
not use scrapers or other sharp instrument that may 2. Dry with a soft cloth.
scratch the elements.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 453
Seat Belt Maintenance
Cleaning
Do not bleach, dye, or clean the belts with chemical Soak the rubber cupholder liner in a mixture of medium
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric. hot tap water and one teaspoon of mild liquid dish soap.
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
Let soak for approximately one hour. After one hour pull
the liner from the water and dip it back into the water
If the belts need cleaning, use MOPAR威 Total Clean, a
about six times. This will loosen any remaining debris.
mild soap solution, or lukewarm water. Do not remove
Rinse the liner thoroughly under warm running water.
the belts from the vehicle to wash them. Dry with a soft
Shake the excess water from the liner and dry the outer
cloth.
surfaces with a clean soft cloth.
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the
Installation
buckles do not work properly.
Align the liner in the cupholder and press down firmly.
Cleaning Center Console Cupholders
Removal
Grab the rubber portion of the cupholder and lift upward.
7
454 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FUSES
Integrated Power Module
The Integrated Power Module is located in the engine
compartment near the air cleaner assembly. This center
contains cartridge fuses and mini fuses. A label that
identifies each component may be printed on the inside
of the cover. Refer to the graphic below for FUSES/TIPM
location.
Integrated Power Module
Cavity
1
Cartridge
Fuse
40 Amp
Green
Mini
Fuse
—
Description
Power Top Module
– If Equipped
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 455
2
Cartridge
Fuse
—
3
—
4
—
5
—
6
—
Cavity
7
—
Mini
Fuse
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
30 Amp
Green
Description
Brake Vacuum
Pump
Center High
Mounted Stop
Light (CHMSL)/
Brake Switch
Ignition Switch
Trailer Tow – If
Equipped
Power Mirror
Switch/Climate
Controls
Ignition Off Draw
(IOD) Sense 1
Cavity
8
Cartridge
Fuse
—
Mini
Fuse
30 Amp
Green
9
40 Amp
Green
10
—
20 Amp
Yellow
11
—
15 Amp
Lt Blue
12
—
13
—
20 Amp
Yellow
20 Amp
Yellow
Description
Ignition Off Draw
(IOD) Sense 2
Battery Feed –
Power Seats – If
Equipped
Instrument Panel/
Power Locks/
Interior Lights
Selectable Power
Outlet (Inside Center Arm Rest)
—
Ignition/Cigar
Lighter
7
456 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
14
15
Cartridge
Fuse
—
16
40 Amp
Green
—
17
—
18
19
40 Amp
Green
—
Mini
Fuse
10 Amp
Red
—
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
10 Amp
Red
—
20 Amp
Yellow
Instrument Panel
20
Cartridge
Fuse
—
Radiator Fan Relay
21
—
Sunroof – If
Equipped
Wireless Control
Module (WCM)/
Clock/Steering
Control Module
(SCM)
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay
Audio Amplifier –
If Equipped
22
—
23
—
24
—
25
—
Description
Cavity
Mini
Fuse
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
25 Amp
Natural
10 Amp
Red
Description
Radio
Siren – If Equipped
Ignition Run – Climate Controls/Hot
Cupholder – If
Equipped
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 3
Sunroof – If
Equipped
Ignition Run —
Heated Mirrors - If
Equipped
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 457
26
Cartridge
Fuse
—
27
—
Cavity
28
29
—
—
Mini
Fuse
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
—
Description
Cavity
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 2
Ignition Run – Occupant Classification Module
(OCM)/Occupant
Restraint Controller
(ORC)
Ignition Run — Occupant Classification Module
(OCM)/Occupant
Restraint Controller
(ORC)
Hot Car (No Fuse
Required)
30
31
32
33
Cartridge
Fuse
—
Mini
Fuse
20 Amp
Yellow
—
30 Amp
Pink
—
—
—
10 Amp
Red
Description
Ignition Run –
Heated Seats – If
Equipped
Spare
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 1
Switch Bank/
Diagnostic Link
Connector/
Powertrain Control
Module (PCM)
7
458 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
34
35
Cartridge
Fuse
30 Amp
Pink
40 Amp
Green
Mini
Fuse
—
—
Description
Cavity
Anti-Lock Brakes
(ABS) Module – If
Equipped/
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) Module – If Equipped
Anti-Lock Brakes
(ABS) Module – If
Equipped/
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) Module – If Equipped
36
37
Cartridge
Fuse
30 Amp
Pink
Mini
Fuse
—
—
25 Amp
Natural
Description
Passenger Door
Module (PDM)/
Driver Door Module (DDM)
Power Top Module
– If Equipped
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 459
CAUTION!
• When installing the Integrated Power Module
cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly
positioned and fully latched. Failure to do so may
allow water to get into the Integrated Power Module, and possibly result in an electrical system
failure.
• When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use
only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The
use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may
result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If
a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates
a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
VEHICLE STORAGE
If you will not be using your vehicle for more than 21
days, you may want to take steps to preserve your
battery.
• Disengage the mini-fuse in the Power Distribution
Center labeled IOD (Ignition Off-Draw).
• Or disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
• Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of
service (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the
air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes
in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will
ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the
possibility of compressor damage when the system is
started again.
7
460 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
REPLACEMENT BULBS
Exterior Bulbs
Interior Bulbs
Front Courtesy/
Reading Lamp
Center Courtesy/
Reading Lamp
Visor Vanity Lamp
Glove Box Lamp
Shift Indicator Lamp
Rear Compartment
(Trunk) Lamp
Bulb Number
578/W5W
578/W5W
A6220
A6220
IKLE14140
579
NOTE: For lighted switches, see your authorized
dealer for replacement.
Bi-Halogen
Headlamp
Front Turn
Signal Lamp
Front Park Lamp
Front Fog Lamp
Center High
Mounted Stop
(CHMSL) Lamp
Rear Tail/Stop/
Turn Signal
Lamp
Backup Lamp
License Lamp
Bulb Number
HIR2
3157NAK
LED
(Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
H11
LED
(Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED
(Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
921
W5W
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 461
BULB REPLACEMENT
Headlamp
1. Raise and prop open the hood. Locate the connector
behind the headlamp.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the air cleaner
filter housing and position the totally integrated power
module aside prior to replacing the low beam headlamp
on the driver’s side of the vehicle.
2. Reach into engine compartment and from behind the
lamp assembly and grasp the connector.
3. Rotate bulb and connector one-quarter turn and pull
outward from assembly.
7
462 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not touch the new bulb with your fingers. Oil
contamination will severely shorten bulb life.
4. Pull the bulb out of the socket and replace the bulb.
5. If the bulb comes in contact with any oily surface,
clean the bulb with rubbing alcohol.
6. Reinsert the bulb and socket assembly and rotate
clockwise one-quarter turn to secure.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 463
Front Turn Signal
1. Raise and prop open the hood.
1. Rotate the bulb’s electrical connector one-quarter turn
counterclockwise and remove it from the fog lamp
housing.
2. Rotate the bulb’s electrical connector one-quarter turn
2. Remove the bulb from the connector socket and install
counterclockwise and remove it from the headlamp
the replacement bulb.
housing.
3. Remove the bulb from the connector socket and install
the replacement bulb.
4. Install the bulb and connector assembly into the
headlamp housing and rotate the connector onequarter turn clockwise to lock it in place.
Front Fog Lamp
NOTE: Access to the lamps through the lower fascia
cutout is limited. We recommend you access the lamps by
turning the steering wheel to allow access and remove
the inner fender shield.
CAUTION!
Do not touch the new bulb with your fingers. Oil
contamination will severely shorten bulb life. If the
bulb comes in contact with an oily surface, clean the
bulb with rubbing alcohol.
3. Install the bulb and connector assembly into the fog
lamp housing and rotate the connector one-quarter
turn clockwise to lock it in place.
7
464 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Placing a small flat head screwdriver or similar
tool between the lamp outboard ball stud and plastic
1. Open the trunk and gently pull back the trunk liner
grommet from inside the trunk can help to disengage the
behind the tail lamp (requires removal of a push pin
outboard edge of the tail lamp.
holding the trunk trim in place near the tail lamp).
3. Grasp the tail lamp by both the outboard and inboard
2. Remove the two plastic wing nuts from the tail lamp
sides, and pull firmly to disengage the tail lamp from
housing.
the vehicle.
Backup Lamps
NOTE: It is normal to hear a loud sound when the lower
tail lamp area unsnaps from the vehicle mounting
bracket during tail lamp removal.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 465
License Plate Lamp
1. Using a small screwdriver, press inward the locking
tab on the side of the lamp assembly and pull down on
the lamp assembly for removal.
2. Pull bulb from socket, replace, and reinstall the lamp
assembly into place ensuring the locking tab is secure.
4. Twist and remove socket from lamp.
5. Remove bulb from socket and replace.
6. Reinstall the tail lamp, fasteners, and trunk liner.
7
466 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUID CAPACITIES
Fuel (Approximate)
All Engines — (Except 2.4L PZEV)
2.4L PZEV (Partial Zero Emissions Vehicle)
Engine Oil With Filter
2.4L Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
3.6L Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
Cooling System*
2.4L Engine (MOPAR威 Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula or equivalent)
3.6L Engine (MOPAR威 Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula or equivalent)
* Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX
U.S.
Metric
16.9 Gallons
18.5 Gallons
64 Liters
70 Liters
4.5 Quarts
6 Quarts
4.4 Liters
5.6 Liters
7.7 Quarts
7.3 Liters
11.6 Quarts
11 Liters
level.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 467
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
Component
Engine Coolant
Engine Oil – 2.4L Engine
Engine Oil – 3.6L Engine
Engine Oil Filter
Spark Plugs – 2.4L Engine except PZEV*
Spark Plugs – 2.4L with PZEV*
Spark Plugs – 3.6L Engine
Fuel Selection
* PZEV = Partial Zero Emission Vehicle
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000
Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology).
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395. Refer to your
engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting
Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395. Refer to your engine oil filler cap
for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Engine Oil Filter.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Spark Plugs.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Spark Plugs.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Spark Plugs.
87 Octane
7
468 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Chassis
Component
Automatic Transmission
Brake Master Cylinder
Power Steering Reservoir
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR威 ATF+4威 Automatic
Transmission Fluid.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 DOT 3 and SAE
J1703. If DOT 3 brake fluid is not available, then DOT 4
is acceptable.
We recommend you use MOPAR威 Power Steering Fluid
+4, MOPAR威 ATF+4威 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
M
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
▫ Maintenance Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .472 N
C
E
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .470
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
M
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
470 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
than your authorized dealer, the message can be reset by
referring to the steps described under “Electronic Vehicle
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change
Information Center (EVIC)/Oil Change Required” in
indicator system. The oil change indicator system will
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further inremind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for
formation
scheduled maintenance.
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change interBased on engine operation conditions, the oil change
vals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months,
indicator message will illuminate. This means that serwhichever comes first.
vice is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions
such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or Once A Month Or Before A Long Trip:
cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will
• Check engine oil level
influence when the “Oil Change Required” message is
displayed. Severe Operating Conditions can cause the • Check windshield washer fluid level
change oil message to illuminate as early as 3,500 miles
(5,600 km) since last reset. Have your vehicle serviced as • Check the tire inflation pressures and look for unusual
wear or damage
soon as possible, within the next 500 miles (805 km).
• Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir, brake
Your authorized dealer will reset the oil change indicator
master cylinder, power steering and transmission as
message after completing the scheduled oil change. If a
needed
scheduled oil change is performed by someone other
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 471 M
• Check function of all interior and exterior lights
Required Maintenance Intervals.
Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following
page for the required maintenance intervals.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
• Change oil and filter.
• Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregular wear, even if it occurs before the oil indicator
system turns on.
• Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as
required.
• Inspect automatic transmission fluid if equipped
with dipstick.
• Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, hoses
and park brake.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
• Inspect engine cooling system protection and
hoses.
• Inspect exhaust system.
• Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or
off-road conditions.
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
8
Additional Inspections
Inspect the CV joints.
Inspect front suspension, tie rod
ends, boot seals and replace if
necessary.
Inspect the brake linings, parking
brake function.
Additional Maintenance
Replace engine air filter.
Replace cabin/air conditioning
filter.
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
2
32,000
M 472 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
A
I Maintenance Chart
N
Mileage or time passed
T
(whichever
comes first)
E
N
A
Or Years:
N
Or
Kilometers:
C
E
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace spark plugs
(2.4L Engine). **
Replace spark plugs
(2.4L PZEV Engine Only). **
Replace spark plugs
(3.6L Engine). **
Flush and replace the engine
coolant at 10 years or 150,000
miles (240,000 km) whichever
comes first.
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 473 M
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
Change automatic transmission
fluid and filter if using your vehicle for any of the following: police, taxi, fleet, or frequent trailer
towing.
Change automatic transmission
fluid and filter.
Inspect and replace PCV valve if
necessary.
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
32,000
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
M 474 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
A
I
Mileage or time passed
N
(whichever comes first)
T
E
N
Or Years:
A
Or
Kilometers:
N
C
E
X
** The spark plug change interval is mileage based only,
yearly intervals do not apply.
X
X
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 475 M
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .479
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479 䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .482
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .479 䡵 MOPAR威 PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479 䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . .483
▫ Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center. . . . . . .480
▫ Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center . . . . . .480
▫ In Mexico contact: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
▫ In The 50 United States And
Washington, D.C.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
9
478 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .484
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .486
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 479
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealer, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
9
480 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Authorized dealer name
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
correctly and in a timely manner.
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center
solved with this process.
P.O. Box 21–8004
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer.
Phone: (800) 247–9753
They want to know if you need assistance.
• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the con- Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center
cern, you may contact the manufacturer’s customer P.O. Box 1621
center.
Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenPhone: (800) 465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French
ter should include the following information:
• Owner’s name and address
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 481
Mexico, D. F.
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1 800 855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
In Mexico City: 5081-7568
Service Contract
Outside Mexico City: 1-800-505-1300
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you
have any questions about the service contract, call the
manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800)
465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French).
In Mexico contact:
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240
Sante Fe C.P. 05109
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the
manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.
9
482 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
contract documents, and contact the person listed in
those documents.
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
concerns.
WARNING!
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain
vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals
known to the State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects, or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer
and birth defects, or other reproductive harm.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the
DVD, for the terms and provisions of Chrysler Group
LLC warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 483
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your authorized
MOPAR威 fluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories are
dealer, and the manufacturer.
available from an authorized dealer. They are recommended for your vehicle in order to help keep the vehicle To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
Hotline toll free at 1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–
operating at its best.
9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
West Building, Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could http://www.safercar.gov.
cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety In Canada
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
manufacturer.
should contact the Customer Service Department immeIf NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an diately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in defect to the Canadian government should contact Transa group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy port Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and
Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/
MOPAR姞 PARTS
9
484 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
for an order form.
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshootNOTE: A street address is required when ordering
ing and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
Service Manuals
Owner’s Manuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the inforThese Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the
mation that students and professional technicians need in
assistance of service and engineering specialists to acdiagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintainquaint you with specific Chrysler Group LLC vehicles.
ing, servicing, and repairing Chrysler Group LLC veIncluded are starting, operating, emergency and maintehicles. A complete working knowledge of the vehicle,
system, and/or components is written in straightforward nance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities
and safety tips.
language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 485
Call toll free at:
Treadwear
• 1–800–890–4038 (U.S.)
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a
tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well
on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative
performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of
their use, however, and may depart significantly from the
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices,
and differences in road characteristics and climate.
• 1–800–387–1143 (Canada)
Or
Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
• www.techauthority.com
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES
Traction Grades
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
your vehicle.
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction perforAll passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety mance.
requirements in addition to these grades.
9
486 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test
wheel, than the minimum required by law.
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
INDEX
10
488 INDEX
About Your Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
ABS (Anti-Lock Brake System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .437
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
Airbag. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Airbag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Airbag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Airbag Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Airbag, Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Airbag, Window (Side Curtain) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .426
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Air Conditioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Air Conditioning Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
Alarm System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Antenna, Satellite Radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Anti-Theft Security Alarm (Theft Alarm) . . . . . . . . . .19
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Assistance Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Auto Down Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Automatic Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .279
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
INDEX 489
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .445
Fluid and Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .445
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .443
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Auto Unlock, Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Auto Up Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .26
Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . .
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . .
Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . .
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Warning Light . . . . . . . . .
Brake/Transmission Interlock .
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . .
Bulbs, Light . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.441
.324
.441
.441
.322
.213
.301
.460
.101
Calibration, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Capacities, Antifreeze (Engine Coolant). . . . . . . . . . .21
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .466
Caps, Filler
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
Radiator (Coolant Pressure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
10
490 INDEX
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Certification Label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator Light) . .420
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Child Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Cigar Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .449
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Cold Weather Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Compact Disc (CD) Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Compass Variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Computer, Trip/Travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Connector
UCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) . . . . . . . . .265
Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Console, Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
Coolant Pressure Cap (Radiator Cap) . . . . . . . . . . .438
Cooling System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .437
Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .466
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .440
INDEX 491
Dipsticks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .445
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Disabled Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Disposal
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Driving
Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421 E-85 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Deck Lid, Power Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Defroster, Rear Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202 Electric Rear Window Defrost. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 Electric Remote Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Delay (Intermittent) Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . .176
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419 Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Dimmer Switch, Headlight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) . . . . . .225
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Crankcase Ventilation Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Cruise Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
10
492 INDEX
Emergency, In Case of
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Emergency Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . .420
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418
Compartment Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418
Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Oil Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Engine Oil Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Engine Oil Viscosity Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Enhanced Accident Response Feature . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Entry System, Illuminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Exhaust Gas Caution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
INDEX 493
Fabric Care. . . . . . . . . . . .
Filler Location Fuel . . . . . .
Filters
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . .
Air Conditioning . . . . .
Automatic Transmission
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Disposal . . .
Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hazard Warning . . . . .
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . .
Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . .
Flexible Fuel Vehicles
Cruising Range . . . . . .
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel Requirements . . . .
Maintenance . . . . . . . .
Replacement Parts . . . .
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451 Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426 Fluid Level Checks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392 Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 Fog Light Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372 Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
. . . . . . . . . . .296
. . . . . . . . . . .466
. . . . . . . . . . .101
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.445
.441
.436
.423
.468
.467
.168
.463
.160
.409
.364
.373
.367
.365
.365
10
494 INDEX
Filler Cap (Gas Cap)
Filler Door (Gas Cap)
Gasoline . . . . . . . . .
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
Light . . . . . . . . . . .
Materials Added . . .
Methanol . . . . . . . .
Octane Rating . . . . .
Requirements . . . . .
Tank Capacity . . . . .
Fuel, Flexible . . . . . . . .
Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel System Caution . . .
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.210
.210
.364
.210
.211
.367
.365
.364
.364
.466
.369
.373
.374
.454
Gauges
Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Gear Select Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Gross Axle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Hands-Free Phone (Uconnect威) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Hazard
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, or
Gas Cap (Fuel Filler Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365 Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
INDEX 495
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
High Beam/Low Beam Select Switch . . . . . . . . .167
On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Heated Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Heater, Engine Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
Hitches
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
Hood Prop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Infant Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Information Center, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Integrated Power Module (Fuses) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Intermittent Wipers (Delay Wipers). . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
10
496 INDEX
Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394 Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405 Light Bulbs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Back-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Keyless Entry System (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Brake Assist Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
Key, Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Daytime Running . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Indicator . . . .332
Knee Bolster. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Engine Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Lane Change and Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Headlights On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Headlight Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Leaks, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
INDEX 497
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Low Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) . . . . . . . .221
Map Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Security Alarm (Theft Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .461
Theft Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . .210
Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Auto Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Child Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Low Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Malfunction Indicator Light (Check Engine).
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Map/Reading Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.427
.422
.470
.221
.484
.169
.441
10
498 INDEX
Methanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Mini-Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Vanity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Monitor, Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
Mopar Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
MTBE/ETBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Occupant Restraints (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Change Indicator . . . . .
Oil Change Indicator, Reset
Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . .
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . .
Change Interval . . . . . .
Checking . . . . . . . . . .
Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . .
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . .
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Filter Disposal . . . . . . .
Identification Logo . . . .
Materials Added to . . .
Recommendation . . . . .
Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . .
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Filter, Selection . . . . . .
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.214
.214
.216
.216
.423
.466
.216
.423
.423
.426
.426
.426
.424
.425
.424
.425
.425
.426
.212
INDEX 499
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Operating Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Personal Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Phone, Cellular . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Phone, Hands-Free (Uconnect威) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .340
Power
Deck Lid Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) . . . . . . . . . .192
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Preparation for Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Programmable Electronic Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radiator Cap (Coolant Pressure Cap)
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radio Remote Controls . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Cupholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Seat, Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.347
.438
.274
.272
.197
.160
.107
.202
10
500 INDEX
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
Reminder, Seat Belt. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Remote Control
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Remote Keyless Entry (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls . . . . . . . . .272
Remote Starting System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Remote Trunk Release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .460
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
Resetting Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Restraint, Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
Safety, Exhaust Gas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Satellite Radio Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .470
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Adjustable Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage . . . . . . . .51
And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
INDEX 501
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Seat Belts (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Rear Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Security Alarm (Theft Alarm). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .467
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Sentry Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .484
Settings, Personal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
Setting the Clock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Shift Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Side Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Side Window Demisters (Defrosters) . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
Spare Tire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Speed Control (Cruise Control). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Speedometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
10
502 INDEX
Taillights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Telescoping Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Temperature Control, Automatic (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .279
Temperature Gauge, Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Theft Alarm (Security Alarm). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Theft System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Time Delay, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Tire and Loading Information Placard . . . . . . . . . . .339
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Aging (Life of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
Tachometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Cold Weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
Starting and Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Steering
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .272
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .459
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .409
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Supplemental Restraint System - Airbag . . . . . . . . . .60
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
INDEX 503
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . .
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . .
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . .
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . .
Tongue Weight/Trailer Weight . . . .
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
....
....
....
...
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
....
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.394
.352
.339
.356
.220
.485
.347
.353
.355
.333
.335
.348
.394
.351
.385
.352
.333
.381
.377
24-Hour Towing Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Towing Assistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
Cooling System Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
Hitches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
Minimum Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
Trailer and Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Trailer Towing Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Trailer Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Transaxle
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .443
10
504 INDEX
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447
Transmitter Battery Service
(Remote Keyless Entry) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Trip Odometer Reset Button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Trunk Lid (Deck Lid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Trunk Release, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Trunk Release Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Upholstery Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451
Vanity Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Variance, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
Vehicle Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Vehicle Theft Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Viscosity, Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Voice Recognition System (VR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
UCI Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Uconnect威 (Hands-Free Phone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111 Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .210
Understanding Your Instrument Panel. . . . . . . . . . .208 Warnings and Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) Connector . . . .265
INDEX 505
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .482
Washer
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .449
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .449
Wind Buffeting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Wipers, Intermittent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this vehicle’s
electronic system to provide immunity to radio frequency signals.
Mobile two-way radios and telephone equipment must be installed
properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed
during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly to the
battery and fused as close to the battery as possible. The negative
power connection should be made to body sheet metal adjacent to
the negative battery connection. This connection should not be
fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the roof or the
rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used in mounting antennas
with magnet bases. Magnets may affect the accuracy or operation
of the compass on vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and routed away
from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use only fully shielded
coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to ensure a low
Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than normal
may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the vehicle’s electronic
systems.
Chrysler Group LLC
13C41-126-AC
300
3rd Edition
Printed in U.S.A.